3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
7 @set DATE December 2008
11 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
14 @c Version and Contact Info
15 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
16 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
17 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
19 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
25 @c Subheadings inside a table.
26 @macro tsubheading{text}
36 This manual is for Org (version @value{VERSION}).
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation
41 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
42 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
43 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
44 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
45 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
46 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
48 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
49 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
50 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
52 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
53 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
54 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
55 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
62 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
63 @author by Carsten Dominik
65 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
67 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
71 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
75 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
82 * Introduction:: Getting started
83 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
84 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
85 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
86 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
87 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
88 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
89 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
90 * Capture:: Creating tasks and attaching files
91 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
92 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX fragments and formulas
93 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
94 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
95 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
96 * Extensions:: Add-ons for Org mode
97 * Hacking:: How hack your way around
98 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
99 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
100 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
103 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
107 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
108 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
109 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
110 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
111 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
115 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
116 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
117 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
118 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
119 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
120 * Archiving:: Move done task trees to a different place
121 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
122 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
123 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
124 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
128 * ARCHIVE tag:: Marking a tree as inactive
129 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
133 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
134 * Narrow columns:: Stop wasting space in tables
135 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
136 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
137 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
138 * Org Plot:: Plotting from org tables
142 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
143 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
144 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
145 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
146 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
147 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
148 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
149 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
153 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
154 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
155 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
156 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
157 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
158 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
159 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
160 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
164 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
168 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
169 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
170 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
171 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
172 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
173 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
175 Extended use of TODO keywords
177 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
178 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
179 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
180 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
181 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
182 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
186 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
187 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
191 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
192 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
193 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
195 Properties and Columns
197 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
198 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
199 * Property searches:: Matching property values
200 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
201 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
202 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
206 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
207 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
208 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
212 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
213 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
217 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
218 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
219 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
220 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
221 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
222 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
226 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
227 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
229 Deadlines and scheduling
231 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
232 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
236 * Remember:: Capture new tasks/ideas with little interruption
237 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks.
241 * Setting up Remember:: Some code for .emacs to get things going
242 * Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types
243 * Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs
244 * Refiling notes:: Moving a note or task to a project
248 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
249 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
250 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
251 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
252 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
253 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
254 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
256 The built-in agenda views
258 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
259 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
260 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
261 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
262 * Keyword search:: Finding entries by keyword
263 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
265 Presentation and sorting
267 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
268 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
269 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
273 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
274 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
275 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
276 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing agendas to files
277 * Using the agenda elsewhere:: Using agenda information in other programs
281 * Math symbols:: TeX macros for symbols and Greek letters
282 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
283 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
284 * Processing LaTeX fragments:: Previewing LaTeX processing
285 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
289 * Markup rules:: Which structures are recognized?
290 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
291 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
292 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
293 * ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII
294 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
295 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF
296 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
297 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
301 * Document title:: How the document title is determined
302 * Headings and sections:: The main structure of the exported document
303 * Table of contents:: If, where, how to create a table of contents
304 * Initial text:: Text before the first headline
305 * Lists:: Plain lists are exported
306 * Paragraphs:: What determines beginning and ending
307 * Literal examples:: Source code and other examples
308 * Include files:: Include the contents of a file during export
309 * Tables exported:: Tables are exported richly
310 * Inlined images:: How to inline images during export
311 * Footnotes:: Numbers like [1]
312 * Emphasis and monospace:: To bold or not to bold
313 * TeX macros and LaTeX fragments:: Create special, rich export.
314 * Horizontal rules:: A line across the page
315 * Comment lines:: Some lines will not be exported
319 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
320 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
321 * Links:: Transformation of links for HTML
322 * Images in HTML export::
323 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
324 * Javascript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
328 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invode which commands
329 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal LaTeX code
330 * Sectioning structure:: Changing sectioning in LaTeX output
331 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to LaTeX
332 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into LaTeX output
336 * Configuration:: Defining projects
337 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
338 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
342 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
343 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
344 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
345 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
346 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
347 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
348 * Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files
352 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
353 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
357 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
358 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
359 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
360 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
361 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
362 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
363 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
364 * Bugs:: Things which do not work perfectly
366 Interaction with other packages
368 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
369 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
373 * Extensions in the contrib directory:: These come with the Org distro
374 * Other extensions:: These you have to find on the web.
378 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
379 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs
380 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
381 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
382 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
383 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
385 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
387 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving
388 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
389 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
390 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
395 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
396 @chapter Introduction
400 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
401 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
402 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
403 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
404 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
407 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
411 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
412 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
414 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
415 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
416 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
417 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
418 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
419 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
420 time stamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
421 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
422 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
423 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
424 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
425 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
426 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
429 An important design aspect that distinguishes Org from for example
430 Planner/Muse is that it encourages to store every piece of information
431 only once. In Planner, you have project pages, day pages and possibly
432 other files, duplicating some information such as tasks. In Org,
433 you only have notes files. In your notes you mark entries as tasks,
434 label them with tags and timestamps. All necessary lists like a
435 schedule for the day, the agenda for a meeting, tasks lists selected by
436 tags etc are created dynamically when you need them.
438 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
439 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
440 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
441 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways, for
445 @r{@bullet{} outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
446 @r{@bullet{} ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
447 @r{@bullet{} ASCII table editor with spreadsheet-like capabilities}
448 @r{@bullet{} TODO list editor}
449 @r{@bullet{} full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
450 @r{@bullet{} environment to implement David Allen's GTD system}
451 @r{@bullet{} a basic database application}
452 @r{@bullet{} simple hypertext system, with HTML and LaTeX export}
453 @r{@bullet{} publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
456 Org's automatic, context sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
457 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
458 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
459 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure
460 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
461 the minor Orgstruct mode.
464 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
465 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
466 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials etc. This page is located at
467 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
472 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
473 @section Installation
477 @b{Important:} @i{If Org is part of the Emacs distribution or an
478 XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly to
481 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
482 or @file{.tar} file, or as a GIT archive, you must take the following steps
483 to install it: Go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
484 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
485 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
486 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
487 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
488 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
489 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
492 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
496 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
497 step for this directory:
500 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
503 @b{XEmacs users now need to install the file @file{noutline.el} from
504 the @file{xemacs} sub-directory of the Org distribution. Use the
508 @b{make install-noutline}
511 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
517 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
518 all. If you want to install into the system directories, use
525 @noindent Then add to @file{.emacs}:
528 ;; This line only if Org is not part of the X/Emacs distribution.
529 (require 'org-install)
533 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
537 @cindex global key bindings
538 @cindex key bindings, global
541 @b{Important:} @i{If you use copy-and-paste to copy lisp code from the
542 PDF documentation as viewed by some PDF viewers to your .emacs file, the
543 single quote character comes out incorrectly and the code will not work.
544 You need to fix the single quotes by hand, or copy from Info
548 Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
549 define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
550 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} - please choose suitable
554 ;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
555 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
556 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
557 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
558 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
561 Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
562 buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
563 active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
564 (XEmacs user must use the second option):
566 (global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
567 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
570 @cindex Org mode, turning on
571 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
572 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
576 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
579 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
580 the file's name is. See also the variable
581 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
583 Many commands in Org work on the region is he region is active. To make use
584 of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode} (@code{zmacs-regions} in
585 XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default, in Emacs 22 you need to
586 do this yourself with
589 (transient-mark-mode 1)
592 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
599 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
600 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
601 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be reviewed by a
602 moderator and then passed through to the list.
604 For bug reports, please provide as much information as possible,
605 including the version information of Emacs (@kbd{C-h v emacs-version
606 @key{RET}}) and Org (@kbd{C-h v org-version @key{RET}}), as well as
607 the Org related setup in @file{.emacs}. If an error occurs, a
608 backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to create one). Often a
609 small example file helps, along with clear information about:
612 @item What exactly did you do?
613 @item What did you expect to happen?
614 @item What happened instead?
616 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this mode.
618 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
620 @cindex backtrace of an error
621 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
622 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
623 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{Backtrace}.
624 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
625 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
629 Start a fresh Emacs or XEmacs, and make sure that it will load the
630 original Lisp code in @file{org.el} instead of the compiled version in
631 @file{org.elc}. The backtrace contains much more information if it is
632 produced with uncompiled code. To do this, either rename @file{org.elc}
633 to something else before starting Emacs, or ask Emacs explicitly to load
634 @file{org.el} by using the command line
636 emacs -l /path/to/org.el
639 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
640 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
642 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
643 document the steps you take.
645 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
646 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
647 attach it to your bug report.
650 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
651 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
653 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
654 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
659 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
663 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
664 meaning are written with all capitals.
667 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
668 special meaning are written with all capitals.
671 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
672 @chapter Document Structure
673 @cindex document structure
674 @cindex structure of document
676 Org is based on outline mode and provides flexible commands to
677 edit the structure of the document.
680 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
681 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
682 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
683 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
684 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
685 * Archiving:: Move done task trees to a different place
686 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
687 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
688 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
689 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
692 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
697 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
698 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
699 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
700 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
701 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
702 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
703 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
704 command @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
706 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
711 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in
712 Org start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See
713 the variable @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e} to configure special behavior
714 of @kbd{C-a} and @kbd{C-e} in headlines.}. For example:
724 * Another top level headline
727 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
728 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
729 starters. @ref{Clean view} describes a setup to realize this.
731 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
732 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
733 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
734 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
735 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
737 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
738 @section Visibility cycling
739 @cindex cycling, visibility
740 @cindex visibility cycling
741 @cindex trees, visibility
742 @cindex show hidden text
745 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
746 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
747 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
749 @cindex subtree visibility states
750 @cindex subtree cycling
751 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
752 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
753 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
757 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
760 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
761 '-----------------------------------'
764 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
765 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
766 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
767 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
768 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
769 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
771 @cindex global visibility states
772 @cindex global cycling
773 @cindex overview, global visibility state
774 @cindex contents, global visibility state
775 @cindex show all, global visibility state
779 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
782 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
783 '--------------------------------------'
786 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
787 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
788 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
790 @cindex show all, command
791 @kindex C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
792 @item C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
793 Show all, including drawers.
796 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
797 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
798 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
799 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
800 level, all sibling headings.
803 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
806 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
809 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
811 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
812 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
813 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
814 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
815 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
816 the previously used indirect buffer.
819 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
820 OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
821 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
822 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
832 Forthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
833 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
834 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
837 @kindex C-u C-u @key{TAB}
838 @item C-u C-u @key{TAB}
839 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
840 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
844 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
846 @cindex motion, between headlines
847 @cindex jumping, to headlines
848 @cindex headline navigation
849 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
860 Next heading same level.
863 Previous heading same level.
866 Backward to higher level heading.
869 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
870 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
871 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
873 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
874 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
875 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
876 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
877 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
878 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
879 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
881 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
884 See also the variable@code{org-goto-interface}.
887 @node Structure editing, Archiving, Motion, Document Structure
888 @section Structure editing
889 @cindex structure editing
890 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
891 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
892 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
893 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
894 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
895 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
896 @cindex copying, of subtrees
897 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
902 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
903 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
904 creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
905 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
906 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
907 the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
908 customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
909 command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
910 created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
911 the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
912 used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
913 of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
914 after the end of the subtree.
917 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
918 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
919 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
920 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
922 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading.
923 @kindex C-S-@key{RET}
925 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
926 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
930 Promote current heading by one level.
931 @kindex M-@key{right}
933 Demote current heading by one level.
934 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
936 Promote the current subtree by one level.
937 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
938 @item M-S-@key{right}
939 Demote the current subtree by one level.
942 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
944 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
946 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
949 Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
950 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
953 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
957 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
958 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
959 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
960 headline marker like @samp{****}.
963 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
964 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
965 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
966 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, level adjustment will take place and
967 yanked trees will be folded unless doing so would swallow text previously
968 visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal @code{yank}
969 to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to force a normal
970 yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a yank, it will yank
971 previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and folding.
974 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
977 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
978 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
979 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
980 alphabetically, numerically, by time (using the first time stamp in each
981 entry), by priority, or by TODO keyword (in the sequence the keywords have
982 been defined in the setup). Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can
983 also supply your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u}
984 prefix, sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes,
985 duplicate entries will also be removed.
988 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
991 Widen buffer to remove a narrowing.
994 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it
995 becomes a subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a
996 normal line by removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn
997 all lines in the region into headlines. Or, if the first line is a
998 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1001 @cindex region, active
1002 @cindex active region
1003 @cindex Transient mark mode
1004 When there is an active region (Transient mark mode), promotion and
1005 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1006 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1007 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1008 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1009 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1012 @node Archiving, Sparse trees, Structure editing, Document Structure
1016 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
1017 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
1018 agenda. Org mode knows two ways of archiving. You can mark a tree with
1019 the ARCHIVE tag, or you can move an entire (sub)tree to a different
1023 * ARCHIVE tag:: Marking a tree as inactive
1024 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
1027 @node ARCHIVE tag, Moving subtrees, Archiving, Archiving
1028 @subsection The ARCHIVE tag
1029 @cindex internal archiving
1031 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
1032 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
1035 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
1036 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
1037 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
1038 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
1039 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
1041 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
1042 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
1043 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
1045 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
1046 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
1047 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
1048 be included. In the agenda you can press the @kbd{v} key to get archives
1049 temporarily included.
1051 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
1052 is. Configure the details using the variable
1053 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
1056 The following commands help managing the ARCHIVE tag:
1061 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
1062 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
1064 @kindex C-u C-c C-x a
1066 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
1067 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
1068 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
1069 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
1070 level 1 trees will be checked.
1073 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
1076 @node Moving subtrees, , ARCHIVE tag, Archiving
1077 @subsection Moving subtrees
1078 @cindex external archiving
1080 Once an entire project is finished, you may want to move it to a different
1081 location. Org can move it to an @emph{Archive Sibling} in the same tree, to a
1082 different tree in the current file, or to a different file, the archive file.
1087 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
1088 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}
1089 (@pxref{ARCHIVE tag}). The entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this
1090 way retains a lot of its original context, including inherited tags and
1091 approximate position in the outline.
1094 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
1095 given by @code{org-archive-location}. Context information that could be
1096 lost like the file name, the category, inherited tags, and the TODO
1097 state will be store as properties in the entry.
1098 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s
1099 @item C-u C-c C-x C-s
1100 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
1101 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
1102 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
1103 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
1104 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
1107 @cindex archive locations
1108 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
1109 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
1110 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
1111 see the documentation string of the variable
1112 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
1113 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
1114 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
1115 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
1116 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
1117 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
1118 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
1119 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using a property.}:
1122 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
1126 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
1127 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
1128 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
1130 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
1131 record context information like the file from where the entry came, it's
1132 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
1133 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
1136 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Archiving, Document Structure
1137 @section Sparse trees
1138 @cindex sparse trees
1139 @cindex trees, sparse
1140 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1141 @cindex occur, command
1143 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1144 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1145 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1146 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1147 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1148 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1149 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1150 and you will see immediately how it works.
1152 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1153 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1158 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1161 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1162 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1163 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1164 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1165 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1166 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1167 editing command@footnote{depending on the option
1168 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1169 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1170 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1174 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1175 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1176 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1177 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1181 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1182 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1185 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1186 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1188 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1189 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1192 @cindex printing sparse trees
1193 @cindex visible text, printing
1194 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1195 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1196 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1197 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1198 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1199 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1201 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1202 @section Plain lists
1204 @cindex lists, plain
1205 @cindex lists, ordered
1206 @cindex ordered lists
1208 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1209 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
1210 checkboxes (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists,
1211 and the HTML exporter (@pxref{Exporting}) parses and formats them.
1213 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1216 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1217 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1218 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1219 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1220 visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1221 @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1224 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1225 a right parenthesis, such as @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}.
1227 @emph{Description} list items are like unordered list items, but contain the
1228 separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
1232 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1233 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1234 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1235 list. Indentation also determines the end of a list item. It ends before
1236 the next line that is indented like the bullet/number, or less. Empty lines
1237 are part of the previous item, so you can have several paragraphs in one
1238 item. If you would like an empty line to terminate all currently open plain
1239 lists, configure the variable @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.
1244 ** Lord of the Rings
1245 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1246 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1247 2. Eowyns fight with the witch king
1248 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1249 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1250 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1252 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1253 But in the end, not individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1254 Important actors in this film are:
1255 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays the Frodo
1256 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays the Sam, Frodos friend. I still remember
1257 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh a in the Goonies.
1261 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to
1262 deal with them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling
1263 settings for Emacs. For XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones'
1264 @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on, put into @file{.emacs}:
1265 @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them properly
1266 (@pxref{Exporting}).
1268 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line
1269 of an item (the line with the bullet or number).
1274 Items can be folded just like headline levels if you set the variable
1275 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. The level of an item is then
1276 given by the indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always
1277 subordinate to real headlines, however; the hierarchies remain
1278 completely separated.
1280 If @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists} has not been set, @key{TAB}
1281 fixes the indentation of the current line in a heuristic way.
1284 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1285 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1286 of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1287 item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1288 @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed in the
1289 @emph{whitespace before a bullet or number}, the new item is created
1290 @emph{before} the current item. If the command is executed in the white
1291 space before the text that is part of an item but does not contain the
1292 bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
1293 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1295 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1297 @kindex S-@key{down}
1300 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list.
1301 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1302 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1304 @itemx M-S-@key{down}
1305 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1306 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1308 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1309 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1310 @item M-S-@key{left}
1311 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1312 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1313 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation.
1314 When these commands are executed several times in direct succession,
1315 the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation
1316 would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break
1317 the command chain with a cursor motion or so.
1320 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1321 state of the checkbox. If not, this command makes sure that all the
1322 items on this list level use the same bullet. Furthermore, if this is
1323 an ordered list, make sure the numbering is OK.
1326 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1327 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}). With a numeric prefix
1328 argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active
1329 region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1330 first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed from the
1331 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1332 converted into a list item.
1333 @kindex S-@key{left}
1334 @kindex S-@key{right}
1335 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1336 Also cycle bullet styles when in the first line of an item.
1339 @node Drawers, Orgstruct mode, Plain lists, Document Structure
1342 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1344 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1345 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1346 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1347 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1348 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1352 ** This is a headline
1353 Still outside the drawer
1355 This is inside the drawer.
1360 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will
1361 hide and show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line.
1362 In order to look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the
1363 drawer line and press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses a drawer for
1364 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and another one for
1365 storing clock times (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
1367 @node Orgstruct mode, , Drawers, Document Structure
1368 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1369 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1370 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1372 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1373 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes
1374 like Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode Orgstruct mode
1375 makes this possible. You can always toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x
1376 orgstruct-mode}. To turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode,
1380 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1383 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to
1384 Org like a headline of the first line of a list item, most
1385 structure editing commands will work, even if the same keys normally
1386 have different functionality in the major mode you are using. If the
1387 cursor is not in one of those special lines, Orgstruct mode lurks
1388 silently in the shadow.
1390 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1393 @cindex editing tables
1395 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1396 calculations are supported in connection with the Emacs @file{calc}
1399 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1402 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1407 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1408 * Narrow columns:: Stop wasting space in tables
1409 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1410 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1411 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1412 * Org Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1415 @node Built-in table editor, Narrow columns, Tables, Tables
1416 @section The built-in table editor
1417 @cindex table editor, built-in
1419 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
1420 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1421 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1425 | Name | Phone | Age |
1426 |-------+-------+-----|
1427 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1428 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1431 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1432 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1433 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1434 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1435 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1436 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1437 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1438 create the above table, you would only type
1445 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1448 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1449 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1450 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1451 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1452 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1453 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1454 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1455 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1458 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1461 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1462 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1463 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1464 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1465 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1466 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1467 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1469 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1470 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1471 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1473 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1476 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1480 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1485 Re-align, move to previous field.
1489 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1490 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1491 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1493 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1494 @kindex M-@key{left}
1495 @kindex M-@key{right}
1497 @itemx M-@key{right}
1498 Move the current column left/right.
1500 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1501 @item M-S-@key{left}
1502 Kill the current column.
1504 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1505 @item M-S-@key{right}
1506 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1509 @kindex M-@key{down}
1512 Move the current row up/down.
1514 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1516 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1518 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1519 @item M-S-@key{down}
1520 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1521 created below the current one.
1525 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
1526 is created above the current line.
1530 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
1531 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
1532 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
1533 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
1534 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
1535 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
1536 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
1537 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
1538 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
1540 @tsubheading{Regions}
1543 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point
1544 and mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. The process ignores
1545 horizontal separator lines.
1549 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
1550 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
1554 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
1555 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
1556 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
1557 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
1564 Wrap several fields in a column like a paragraph. If there is an active
1565 region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the
1566 column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric
1567 prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there
1568 is no region, the current field is split at the cursor position and the text
1569 fragment to the right of the cursor is prepended to the field one line
1570 down. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current
1571 field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above.
1573 @tsubheading{Calculations}
1574 @cindex formula, in tables
1575 @cindex calculations, in tables
1576 @cindex region, active
1577 @cindex active region
1578 @cindex Transient mark mode
1581 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
1582 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
1583 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
1587 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
1588 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
1589 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
1590 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
1591 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily dispables the
1592 increment. This key is also used by CUA mode (@pxref{Cooperation}).
1594 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
1597 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields
1598 that are not fully visible (@pxref{Narrow columns}). When called with a
1599 @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
1602 @item M-x org-table-import
1603 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB- or whitespace
1604 separated. Useful, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
1605 from a database, because these programs generally can write
1606 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
1607 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
1608 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
1611 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
1612 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
1613 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
1615 @item M-x org-table-export
1616 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Useful for data
1617 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
1618 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
1619 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
1620 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
1621 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
1622 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
1623 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions} for a
1624 detailed description.
1627 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
1628 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
1632 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
1635 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
1636 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
1638 @node Narrow columns, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
1639 @section Narrow columns
1640 @cindex narrow columns in tables
1642 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor.
1643 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text,
1644 leading to inconveniently wide columns. To limit@footnote{This feature
1645 does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere in
1646 the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
1647 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next
1648 re-align will then set the width of this column to no more than this
1653 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1655 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
1656 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
1657 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
1658 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
1659 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1664 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
1665 Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible.
1666 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field - a tool-tip window
1667 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
1668 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
1669 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
1672 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
1673 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
1674 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
1675 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
1676 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
1677 on a per-file basis with:
1684 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Narrow columns, Tables
1685 @section Column groups
1686 @cindex grouping columns in tables
1688 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
1689 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
1690 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
1691 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
1692 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
1693 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
1694 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
1695 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
1696 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
1697 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
1700 | | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1701 |---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1702 | / | <> | < | | > | < | > |
1703 | # | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
1704 | # | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
1705 | # | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
1706 |---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1707 #+TBLFM: $3=$2^2::$4=$2^3::$5=$2^4::$6=sqrt($2)::$7=sqrt(sqrt(($2)))
1710 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
1711 every vertical line you'd like to have:
1714 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1715 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1719 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
1720 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
1722 @cindex minor mode for tables
1724 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
1725 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
1726 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
1727 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
1728 example in mail mode, use
1731 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
1734 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
1735 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
1736 construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
1737 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
1738 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
1740 @node The spreadsheet, Org Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
1741 @section The spreadsheet
1742 @cindex calculations, in tables
1743 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
1744 @cindex @file{calc} package
1746 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
1747 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
1748 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's
1749 implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example,
1750 Org knows the concept of a @emph{column formula} that will be
1751 applied to all non-header fields in a column without having to copy the
1752 formula to each relevant field.
1755 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
1756 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
1757 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
1758 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
1759 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
1760 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
1761 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
1762 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
1765 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
1766 @subsection References
1769 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
1770 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
1771 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
1772 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
1773 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
1775 @subsubheading Field references
1776 @cindex field references
1777 @cindex references, to fields
1779 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
1780 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
1781 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
1782 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
1783 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
1784 @c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
1787 Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
1793 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{N},
1794 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
1796 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
1797 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
1798 @samp{1}...@samp{N}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
1799 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
1800 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
1801 hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
1802 starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
1803 the second etc. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
1804 current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
1805 You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
1806 third hline in the table. Relative row numbers like @samp{-3} will not
1807 cross hlines if the current line is too close to the hline. Instead,
1808 the value directly at the hline is used.
1810 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
1811 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
1812 row/column is implied.
1814 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
1815 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
1816 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
1817 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
1818 references because the same reference operator can reference different
1819 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
1821 As a special case references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used to
1822 refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
1825 Here are a few examples:
1828 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
1829 C2 @r{same as previous}
1830 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
1831 E& @r{same as previous}
1832 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
1833 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
1834 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
1837 @subsubheading Range references
1838 @cindex range references
1839 @cindex references, to ranges
1841 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
1842 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
1843 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
1844 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
1845 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
1846 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
1849 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
1850 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
1851 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
1852 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
1853 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
1856 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
1857 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
1858 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
1859 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
1860 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
1862 @subsubheading Named references
1863 @cindex named references
1864 @cindex references, named
1865 @cindex name, of column or field
1866 @cindex constants, in calculations
1868 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
1869 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
1870 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
1874 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
1878 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
1879 constants in table formulas: For a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
1880 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
1881 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
1882 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
1883 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
1884 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{Constant.el} can
1885 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
1886 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
1887 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
1888 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
1889 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
1890 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
1891 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
1894 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
1895 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
1896 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
1897 @cindex syntax, of formulas
1899 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
1900 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
1901 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
1902 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
1903 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
1904 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
1905 Emacs Calc Manual}),
1906 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
1907 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
1908 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
1909 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
1910 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
1912 @cindex format specifier
1913 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
1914 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
1915 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
1916 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
1917 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
1918 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 5)} to keep tables
1919 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
1920 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
1923 p20 @r{switch the internal precision to 20 digits}
1924 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed display format}
1925 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
1926 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
1927 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
1928 T @r{force text interpretation}
1929 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
1933 In addition, you may provide a @code{printf} format specifier to
1934 reformat the final result. A few examples:
1937 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
1938 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
1939 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
1940 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
1941 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
1942 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
1943 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
1944 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
1945 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
1946 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
1947 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
1950 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
1953 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
1956 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
1957 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
1958 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
1960 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful
1961 for string manipulation and control structures, if the Calc's
1962 functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single quote
1963 followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a lisp form.
1964 The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with
1965 @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a
1966 semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way
1967 field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a
1968 reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double quotes)
1969 containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all
1970 referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and
1971 interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the
1972 @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes.
1973 I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp
1974 form, enclose the reference operator itself in double quotes, like
1975 @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
1976 embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the
1977 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in lisp.
1980 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
1981 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
1982 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to the Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
1984 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
1985 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
1988 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
1989 @subsection Field formulas
1990 @cindex field formula
1991 @cindex formula, for individual table field
1993 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
1994 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
1995 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
1996 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
1997 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
1999 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2000 directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of
2001 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2002 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2003 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2004 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
2005 same field. Of cause this is not true if you edit the table structure
2006 with normal editing commands - then you must fix the equations yourself.
2007 The left hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
2008 features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2010 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2016 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2017 formula, with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2018 it to the current field and stores it.
2021 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2022 @subsection Column formulas
2023 @cindex column formula
2024 @cindex formula, for table column
2026 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2027 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2028 in that column, Org allows to assign a single formula to an entire
2029 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2030 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2031 and will not be modified by column formulas.
2033 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2034 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2035 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the
2036 field, the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column,
2037 evaluated and the current field replaced with the result. If the field
2038 contains only @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is
2039 used. For each column, Org will only remember the most recently
2040 used formula. In the @samp{TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like
2043 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2049 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2050 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2051 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2052 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2053 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2056 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2057 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2058 @cindex formula editing
2059 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2061 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2062 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2063 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2064 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2065 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2066 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2067 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2074 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2075 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas} and @ref{Field formulas}.
2076 @kindex C-u C-u C-c =
2078 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2079 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2080 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2081 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2084 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2085 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2088 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
2089 overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned, you can
2090 force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2093 Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below.
2096 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2097 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2098 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2099 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2100 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2101 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2107 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2108 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2111 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2114 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2115 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2118 Pretty-print or indent lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2119 a lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2120 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2121 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs lisp mode.
2124 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs lisp mode.
2126 @kindex S-@key{down}
2127 @kindex S-@key{left}
2128 @kindex S-@key{right}
2129 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2130 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2131 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2132 This also works for relative references, and for hline references.
2133 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
2134 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
2135 @item M-S-@key{up}/@key{down}
2136 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2139 @kindex M-@key{down}
2140 @item M-@key{up}/@key{down}
2141 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2144 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2148 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2149 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{TBLFM}
2150 line) - during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2151 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2152 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2155 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2156 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line, or with the normal
2157 recalculation commands in the table.
2159 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2160 @cindex formula debugging
2161 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2162 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2163 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2164 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2165 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2166 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2167 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2169 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2170 @subsection Updating the table
2171 @cindex recomputing table fields
2172 @cindex updating, table
2174 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2175 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features} for a way to make
2176 recalculation at least semi-automatically.
2178 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2184 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2185 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2191 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2192 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2194 @kindex C-u C-u C-c *
2195 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c
2197 @itemx C-u C-u C-c C-c
2198 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2199 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2200 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2203 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2204 @subsection Advanced features
2206 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2207 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2208 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2212 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{},
2213 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2214 change all marks in the region.
2217 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2218 makes use of these features:
2222 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2223 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2224 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2225 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2226 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2227 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2228 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2229 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2230 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2231 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2232 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2233 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2234 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2235 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2236 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2240 @noindent @b{Important}: Please note that for these special tables,
2241 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2242 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2243 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2246 @cindex marking characters, tables
2247 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2250 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2251 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2253 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2254 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2255 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2256 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2258 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2261 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2262 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2263 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2264 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2267 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2268 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2269 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2270 lines will be left alone by this command.
2272 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2273 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2274 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2276 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2277 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2280 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2284 Finally, just to whet your appetite on what can be done with the
2285 fantastic @file{calc} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2286 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2291 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2292 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2293 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2294 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2295 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2296 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2297 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2298 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2299 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2300 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2301 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2306 @node Org Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2308 @cindex graph, in tables
2309 @cindex plot tables using gnuplot
2311 Org Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2312 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2313 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2314 this in action ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot-mode installed
2315 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2319 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2320 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2321 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2322 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2323 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2324 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2325 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2326 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2330 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the tables headers as labels.
2331 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2332 be exercised through the @code{#+Plot:} lines preceding a table. See below
2333 for a complete list of Org plot options. For more information and examples
2334 see the org-plot tutorial at
2335 @uref{http://legito.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
2337 @subsubheading Plot Options
2341 Specify any @file{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2344 Specify the title of the plot.
2347 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2350 Specify the columns to graph as a lisp style list, surrounded by parenthesis
2351 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2352 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the ind
2356 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2359 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2360 (e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2361 Defaults to 'lines'.
2364 If you want to plot to a file specify the @code{"path/to/desired/output-file"}.
2367 List of labels to be used for the deps (defaults to column headers if they
2371 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the gnuplot script.
2374 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2375 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2378 Specify format of org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by gnuplot.
2379 Defaults to '%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S'.
2382 If you want total control you can specify a script file (place the file name
2383 between double quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
2384 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
2385 the path to the generated data file. Note even if you set this option you
2386 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2390 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2394 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2395 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2398 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2399 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2400 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
2401 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2402 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2403 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2404 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2405 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2408 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2409 @section Link format
2411 @cindex format, of links
2413 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2414 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2417 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2420 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2421 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2422 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2423 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2424 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2425 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2426 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2427 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2430 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2431 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2432 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2433 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2434 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2435 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2436 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2438 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2439 @section Internal links
2440 @cindex internal links
2441 @cindex links, internal
2442 @cindex targets, for links
2444 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in
2445 the current file. Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My
2446 Target][Find my target]]} lead to a text search in the current file.
2447 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the
2448 link, or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). The preferred
2449 match for such a link is a dedicated target: the same string in double
2450 angular brackets. Targets may be located anywhere; sometimes it is
2451 convenient to put them into a comment line. For example
2457 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
2458 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
2459 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
2460 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
2463 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for the words in the
2464 link. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
2465 Links starting with a star like @samp{*My Target} restrict the search to
2466 headlines. When searching, Org mode will first try an exact match, but
2467 then move on to more and more lenient searches. For example, the link
2468 @samp{[[*My Targets]]} will find any of the following:
2472 ** TODO my targets are bright
2473 ** my 20 targets are
2476 To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used.
2477 Just type a star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and
2478 press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be
2479 offered as completions. @xref{Handling links}, for more commands
2482 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
2483 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
2484 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
2488 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
2491 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
2492 @subsection Radio targets
2493 @cindex radio targets
2494 @cindex targets, radio
2495 @cindex links, radio targets
2497 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
2498 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
2499 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
2500 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
2501 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
2502 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
2503 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
2504 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
2505 cursor on or at a target.
2507 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
2508 @section External links
2509 @cindex links, external
2510 @cindex external links
2511 @cindex links, external
2519 @cindex WANDERLUST links
2521 @cindex USENET links
2526 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
2527 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
2528 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
2529 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
2530 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
2533 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
2534 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
2535 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
2536 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
2537 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
2538 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
2539 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
2540 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
2541 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
2542 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
2543 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
2544 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
2545 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
2546 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
2547 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
2548 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
2549 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
2550 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
2551 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
2552 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
2553 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
2554 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive elisp command}
2555 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
2558 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
2559 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
2560 format}), for example:
2563 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
2567 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
2568 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
2569 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
2571 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
2573 @cindex angular brackets, around links
2574 @cindex plain text external links
2575 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
2576 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
2577 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
2578 about the end of the link, enclose them in angular brackets.
2580 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
2581 @section Handling links
2582 @cindex links, handling
2584 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
2585 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
2589 @cindex storing links
2591 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command which
2592 can be used in any buffer to create a link. The link will be stored for
2593 later insertion into an Org buffer (see below). For Org files, if there is a
2594 @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points to the target. Otherwise it
2595 points to the current headline, either by text, or, if @file{org-id.el} is
2596 loaded, by ID property. For VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus and BBDB
2597 buffers, the link will indicate the current article/entry. For W3 and W3M
2598 buffers, the link goes to the current URL. For IRC links, if you set the
2599 variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to non-nil then @kbd{C-c l} will store a
2600 @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for the current
2601 conversation. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to the user/channel/server
2602 under the point will be stored. For any other files, the link will point to
2603 the file, with a search string (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the
2604 contents of the current line. If there is an active region, the selected
2605 words will form the basis of the search string. If the automatically created
2606 link is not working correctly or accurately enough, you can write custom
2607 functions to select the search string and to do the search for particular
2608 file types - see @ref{Custom searches}. The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only
2609 a suggestion - see @ref{Installation}.
2612 @cindex link completion
2613 @cindex completion, of links
2614 @cindex inserting links
2616 Insert a link. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer. You
2617 can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
2618 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. All links stored during the
2619 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
2620 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}). Completion, on the other
2621 hand, will help you to insert valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or
2622 @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes defined through link abbreviations
2623 (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). The link will be inserted into the
2624 buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be removed
2625 from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use a
2626 triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
2627 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
2628 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
2629 becomes the default description.@* Note that you don't have to use this
2630 command to insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type
2631 or paste them straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are
2632 automatically enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the
2633 optional descriptive text.
2635 @c If the link is a @samp{file:} link and
2636 @c the linked file is located in the same directory as the current file or
2637 @c a subdirectory of it, the path of the file will be inserted relative to
2638 @c the current directory.
2641 @cindex file name completion
2642 @cindex completion, of file names
2644 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
2645 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
2646 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
2647 directory of the current org file, if the linked file is in the current
2648 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
2649 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
2650 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
2651 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
2653 @item C-c C-l @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
2654 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
2655 link and description parts of the link.
2657 @cindex following links
2660 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
2661 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
2662 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
2663 cursor is on an internal link, this commands runs the corresponding search.
2664 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
2665 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a time stamp, it compiles the agenda for that
2666 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
2667 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
2668 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
2669 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
2670 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
2671 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.
2677 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
2678 would. Under Emacs 22, also @kbd{mouse-1} will follow a link.
2682 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
2683 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
2684 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
2689 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
2690 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
2692 @cindex links, returning to
2695 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
2696 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
2697 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
2698 previously recorded positions.
2702 @cindex links, finding next/previous
2705 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
2706 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
2707 bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also
2708 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
2710 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
2712 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
2713 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
2717 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
2718 @section Using links outside Org
2720 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
2721 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
2722 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
2726 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
2727 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
2730 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
2731 @section Link abbreviations
2732 @cindex link abbreviations
2733 @cindex abbreviation, links
2735 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
2736 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
2737 abbreviated link looks like this
2740 [[linkword:tag][description]]
2744 where the tag is optional. Such abbreviations are resolved according to
2745 the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist} that
2746 relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
2750 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
2751 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
2752 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
2753 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/
2754 nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
2758 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
2759 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
2760 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
2761 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
2763 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
2764 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
2765 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]} and find out what the Org author is
2766 doing besides Emacs hacking with @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
2768 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
2769 can define them in the file with
2772 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
2773 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
2777 In-buffer completion @pxref{Completion} can be used after @samp{[} to
2778 complete link abbreviations.
2780 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
2781 @section Search options in file links
2782 @cindex search option in file links
2783 @cindex file links, searching
2785 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
2786 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
2787 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
2788 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
2789 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
2790 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
2791 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
2792 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
2794 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
2795 link, together with an explanation:
2798 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
2799 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
2800 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
2801 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
2808 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
2809 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
2810 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
2811 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
2814 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
2816 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
2817 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
2818 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
2819 sparse tree with the matches.
2820 @c If the target file is a directory,
2821 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
2824 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
2825 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
2826 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
2827 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
2829 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
2830 @section Custom Searches
2831 @cindex custom search strings
2832 @cindex search strings, custom
2834 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
2835 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
2836 cases. For example, BibTeX database files have many entries like
2837 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
2838 because the only unique identification for a BibTeX entry is the
2841 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
2842 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
2843 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
2844 to be added to the hook variables
2845 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
2846 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
2847 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
2848 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
2849 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
2851 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
2855 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
2856 course, you can make a document that contains inly long lists of TODO items,
2857 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
2858 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
2859 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
2860 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
2861 item emerged is always present.
2863 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
2864 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
2865 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
2868 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
2869 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
2870 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
2871 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
2872 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
2873 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
2876 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
2877 @section Basic TODO functionality
2879 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
2880 @samp{TODO}, for example:
2883 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
2887 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
2891 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
2893 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
2896 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
2897 '--------------------------------'
2900 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
2901 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
2905 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
2906 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
2907 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords} and @ref{Setting tags} for
2910 @kindex S-@key{right}
2911 @kindex S-@key{left}
2914 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
2915 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
2919 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
2922 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds
2923 the entire buffer, but shows all TODO items and the headings hierarchy
2924 above them. With a prefix argument, search for a specific TODO. You will be
2925 prompted for the keyword, and you can also give a list of keywords like
2926 @code{KWD1|KWD2|...}. With numeric prefix argument N, show the tree for the
2927 Nth keyword in the variable @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix
2928 arguments, find all TODO and DONE entries.
2931 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items from all agenda
2932 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new buffer will
2933 be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
2934 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda
2935 commands}). @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
2936 @kindex S-M-@key{RET}
2938 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
2942 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
2943 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
2945 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
2946 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
2947 @cindex extended TODO keywords
2949 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
2950 DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
2951 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
2952 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
2955 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
2956 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
2959 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
2960 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
2961 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
2962 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
2963 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
2964 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
2967 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
2968 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
2969 @cindex TODO workflow
2970 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
2972 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
2973 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
2974 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
2978 (setq org-todo-keywords
2979 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
2982 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
2983 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
2984 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
2986 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
2987 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
2988 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
2989 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
2990 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
2991 Or you can use @kbd{S-left} to go backward through the sequence. If you
2992 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
2993 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
2994 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
2995 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
2996 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes} for more information.
2998 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
2999 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3001 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3002 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3004 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3005 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3006 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3007 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3008 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3009 be set up like this:
3012 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3015 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3016 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3017 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3018 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3019 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3020 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3021 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3022 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3023 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3024 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3025 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c C-v}. For example, to see all things
3026 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c C-v}. To collect Lucy's items
3027 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3028 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c t}.
3030 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3031 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3032 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3034 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3035 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3036 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3037 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3038 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3042 (setq org-todo-keywords
3043 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3044 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3045 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3048 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3049 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3050 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3051 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3052 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3053 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3054 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3057 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3058 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3059 @item C-S-@key{right}
3060 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3061 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3062 @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or @code{DONE} to
3063 @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to @code{CANCELED}.
3064 @kindex S-@key{right}
3065 @kindex S-@key{left}
3068 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through
3069 @emph{all} keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}}
3070 would switch from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above.
3073 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3074 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3076 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3077 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3078 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3079 key after each keyword, in parenthesis. For example:
3082 (setq org-todo-keywords
3083 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3084 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3085 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3088 If you then press @code{C-u C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the
3089 entry will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove
3090 any TODO keyword from an entry. Should you like this way of selecting
3091 TODO states a lot, you might want to set the variable
3092 @code{org-use-fast-todo-selection} to @code{t} and make this behavior
3093 the default. Check also the variable
3094 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows to change the TODO
3095 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you
3096 like to mingle the two concepts.
3098 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3099 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3100 @cindex keyword options
3101 @cindex per-file keywords
3103 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3104 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3105 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3106 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3107 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3111 #+SEQ_TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3115 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3118 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3121 #+SEQ_TODO: TODO | DONE
3122 #+SEQ_TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3123 #+SEQ_TODO: | CANCELED
3126 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3128 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3129 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3131 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3132 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3133 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3134 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3135 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3136 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
3137 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3138 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
3139 for the current buffer.}.
3141 @node Faces for TODO keywords, , Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3142 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3143 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3145 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3146 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3147 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3148 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3149 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3150 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3154 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3155 '(("TODO" . org-warning)
3156 ("DEFERRED" . shadow)
3157 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3161 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED
3162 @emph{should} work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If
3163 necessary, define a special face and use that.
3166 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3167 @section Progress logging
3168 @cindex progress logging
3169 @cindex logging, of progress
3171 Org mode can automatically record a time stamp and possibly a note when
3172 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3173 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3174 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3175 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3179 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3180 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3183 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3184 @subsection Closing items
3186 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3187 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3188 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}.
3191 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3195 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3196 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3197 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3198 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3199 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3200 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3203 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3207 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3208 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3210 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3211 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
3212 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3213 giving you an overview of what has been done.
3215 @node Tracking TODO state changes, , Closing items, Progress logging
3216 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
3218 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow
3219 states}), you might want to keep track of when a state change occurred
3220 and maybe take a note about this change. Since it is normally too much
3221 to record a note for every state, Org mode expects configuration on a
3222 per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by adding special markers
3223 @samp{!} (for a time stamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note) in parenthesis
3224 after each keyword. For example, with the setting
3227 (setq org-todo-keywords
3228 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
3232 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
3233 request that a time is recorded when the entry is turned into
3234 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two time stamps
3235 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
3236 However, it will never prompt for two notes - if you have configured
3237 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3238 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
3239 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: The
3240 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
3241 entering the state, a time stamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
3242 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3243 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3244 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3245 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3246 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3249 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3252 #+SEQ_TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
3255 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3256 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3257 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3258 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3259 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3260 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3263 * TODO Log each state with only a time
3265 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3267 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3269 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3271 * TODO No logging at all
3277 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
3281 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up enough TODO items that
3282 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
3283 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like
3287 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
3291 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
3292 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie
3293 is treated as priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only in
3294 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they have
3295 no inherent meaning to Org mode.
3297 Priorities can be attached to any outline tree entries; they do not need
3303 Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a
3304 priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press
3305 @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline.
3306 The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3307 agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3310 @kindex S-@key{down}
3313 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the
3314 option @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default'}.}. Note that these
3315 keys are also used to modify time stamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}).
3316 Furthermore, these keys are also used by CUA mode (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3319 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
3320 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
3321 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
3322 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
3323 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
3330 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
3331 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
3332 @cindex tasks, breaking down
3334 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
3335 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
3336 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
3337 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
3338 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
3339 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
3340 be updates each time the todo status of a child changes. For example:
3343 * Organize Party [33%]
3344 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
3348 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
3351 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE when all
3352 chilrden are done, you can use the following setup:
3355 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
3356 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
3357 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
3358 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
3360 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
3364 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
3365 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
3368 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
3372 Every item in a plain list (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a
3373 checkbox by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is
3374 similar to TODO items (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight.
3375 Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are often
3376 great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use
3377 them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or
3378 use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's @file{org-mouse.el}).
3380 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
3383 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
3384 - [-] call people [1/3]
3389 - [ ] think about what music to play
3390 - [X] talk to the neighbors
3393 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
3394 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
3395 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
3398 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
3399 @cindex checkbox statistics
3400 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are
3401 cookies indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been
3402 checked off, and the total number of checkboxes are present. This can
3403 give you an idea on how many checkboxes remain, even without opening a
3404 folded entry. The cookies can be placed into a headline or into (the
3405 first line of) a plain list item. Each cookie covers all checkboxes
3406 structurally below the headline/item on which the cookie appear. You
3407 have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either @samp{[/]} or
3408 @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m} result, as in
3409 the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about the
3410 percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
3411 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively).
3413 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
3418 Toggle checkbox at point. With a prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]},
3419 which is considered to be an intermediate state.
3422 Toggle checkbox at point.
3425 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
3426 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. If you
3427 want to toggle all boxes in the region independently, use a prefix
3430 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
3431 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
3433 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
3435 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
3437 Insert a new item with a checkbox.
3438 This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
3439 (@pxref{Plain lists}).
3442 Update the checkbox statistics in the current outline entry. When
3443 called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox
3444 statistic cookies are updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes
3445 with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. If you
3446 delete boxes or add/change them by hand, use this command to get things
3447 back into synch. Or simply toggle any checkbox twice with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
3450 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
3453 @cindex headline tagging
3454 @cindex matching, tags
3455 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
3457 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
3458 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
3461 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
3462 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
3463 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
3464 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
3465 Tags will by default get a bold face with the same color as the headline.
3466 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
3467 @code{org-tag-faces}, much in the same way as you can do for TODO keywords
3468 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
3471 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
3472 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
3473 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
3476 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
3477 @section Tag inheritance
3478 @cindex tag inheritance
3479 @cindex inheritance, of tags
3480 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
3482 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
3483 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
3484 well. For example, in the list
3487 * Meeting with the French group :work:
3488 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
3489 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
3493 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
3494 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
3495 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
3496 a file should inherit as if these tags would be defined in a hypothetical
3497 level zero that surounds the entire file.
3500 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
3504 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
3505 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
3506 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
3508 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
3509 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
3510 as well@footnote{This is only true if the the search does not involve more
3511 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
3512 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
3513 match in a subtree, configure the variable
3514 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
3516 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
3517 @section Setting tags
3518 @cindex setting tags
3519 @cindex tags, setting
3522 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
3523 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
3524 also a special command for inserting tags:
3529 @cindex completion, of tags
3530 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
3531 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
3532 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
3533 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
3534 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
3535 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
3536 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
3539 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
3542 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
3543 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
3544 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
3545 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
3546 the default tags for a given file with lines like
3549 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
3550 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
3553 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
3554 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
3555 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
3561 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
3562 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
3563 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
3564 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
3565 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
3566 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
3567 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
3568 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
3572 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
3575 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on then you
3576 can, instead, set the TAGS option line as:
3579 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
3583 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive. By using
3587 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
3590 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
3591 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
3593 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
3594 these lines to activate any changes.
3597 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-mode-alist}
3598 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
3599 of the braces. The previous example would be set globally by the following
3603 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
3604 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
3605 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
3607 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
3610 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
3611 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
3612 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
3613 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
3614 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
3619 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
3620 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
3621 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
3624 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
3625 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
3628 Clear all tags for this line.
3631 Accept the modified set.
3633 Abort without installing changes.
3635 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
3637 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
3638 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
3640 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
3641 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
3646 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
3647 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
3648 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
3649 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
3650 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
3651 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
3652 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
3653 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
3655 If you find that most of the time, you need only a single key press to
3656 modify your list of tags, set the variable
3657 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
3658 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection - it will immediately exit
3659 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
3660 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
3661 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
3662 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
3663 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
3664 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
3666 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
3667 @section Tag searches
3668 @cindex tag searches
3669 @cindex searching for tags
3671 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
3672 information into special lists.
3679 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
3680 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
3683 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
3684 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
3687 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
3688 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
3689 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
3692 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag searches
3693 A @i{tags} search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and
3694 @samp{|} for OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}.
3695 Parenthesis are currently not implemented. A tag may also be preceded
3696 by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic sugar for
3697 positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when @samp{+}
3698 or @samp{-} is present. Examples:
3702 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
3705 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
3706 @item work|laptop&night
3707 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
3711 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
3712 You may also test for TODO keywords (@pxref{TODO extensions}) and properties
3713 (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same time as matching tags. For a
3714 guide on how to match properties, see @ref{Property searches}. To match a
3715 specific TODO keyword, include an expression like @samp{+TODO="NEXT"} as one
3716 of the terms in a tags search.
3718 There is also the possibility to end the tags part of the match (which may
3719 include several terms connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then
3720 specify a Boolean expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then
3721 similar to the tag matches, but should be applied with consideration: For
3722 example, a positive selection on several TODO keywords can not meaningfully
3723 be combined with boolean AND. However, @emph{negative selection} combined
3724 with AND can be meaningful. To make sure that only lines are checked that
3725 actually have any TODO keyword (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M},
3726 or equivalently start the TODO part after the slash with @samp{!}. Examples:
3729 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
3730 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
3731 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
3732 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
3733 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
3735 Same as the first example.
3736 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
3737 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
3739 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
3740 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
3744 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
3745 Any element of the tag/todo match can be a regular expression - in this
3746 case it must be enclosed in curly braces. For example,
3747 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
3748 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}. You may also use a
3749 regular expression in @samp{TODO=@{^W@}} which would match TODO keywords
3750 starting with the letter @samp{W}.
3752 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
3753 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
3754 You can also require a headline to be of a certain level or category, by
3755 writing instead of any TAG an expression like @samp{LEVEL=3} or
3756 @samp{CATEGORY="work"}, respectively. For example, a search
3757 @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss/-DONE} lists all level three headlines that have the
3758 tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword DONE.
3760 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
3761 other properties will slow down the search.
3763 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
3764 @chapter Properties and Columns
3767 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
3768 are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First, properties
3769 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
3770 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
3771 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
3772 you document bugs and plan releases of a piece of software. Instead of
3773 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
3774 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
3775 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
3776 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CD's,
3777 where properties could be things such as the album artist, date of
3778 release, number of tracks, and so on.
3780 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
3781 (@pxref{Column view}).
3784 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
3785 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
3786 * Property searches:: Matching property values
3787 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
3788 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
3789 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
3792 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
3793 @section Property syntax
3794 @cindex property syntax
3795 @cindex drawer, for properties
3797 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
3798 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
3799 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
3800 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
3805 *** Goldberg Variations
3807 :Title: Goldberg Variations
3808 :Composer: J.S. Bach
3810 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammphon
3815 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
3816 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
3817 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
3818 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
3819 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
3820 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
3821 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
3826 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
3827 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
3831 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
3832 file, use a line like
3835 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
3838 Property values set with the global variable
3839 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
3843 The following commands help to work with properties:
3848 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
3849 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
3852 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
3853 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
3854 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
3855 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
3856 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
3857 information like deadlines.
3860 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
3862 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
3863 can be inserted using completion.
3864 @kindex S-@key{right}
3865 @kindex S-@key{left}
3866 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
3867 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
3869 Remove a property from the current entry.
3871 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
3873 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
3874 nearest column format definition.
3877 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
3878 @section Special properties
3879 @cindex properties, special
3881 Special properties provide alternative access method to Org mode
3882 features discussed in the previous chapters, like the TODO state or the
3883 priority of an entry. This interface exists so that you can include
3884 these states into columns view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
3885 queries. The following property names are special and should not be
3886 used as keys in the properties drawer:
3889 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
3890 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
3891 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
3892 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
3893 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
3894 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling time stamp, without the angular brackets.}
3895 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less time stamp in the entry.}
3896 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive time stamp in the entry.}
3897 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
3898 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
3901 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
3902 @section Property searches
3903 @cindex properties, searching
3904 @cindex searching, of properties
3906 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
3907 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}), and
3908 the same logic applies. For example, here is a search string:
3911 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
3912 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
3916 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
3919 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
3920 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
3921 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
3923 If the comparison value is enclosed in double
3924 quotes, a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
3926 If the comparison value is enclosed in double quotes @emph{and} angular
3927 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
3928 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
3929 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
3930 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
3931 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
3932 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
3933 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
3934 respectively, can be used.
3936 If the comparison value is enclosed
3937 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
3938 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
3942 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
3943 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
3944 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
3945 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
3946 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
3947 on or after October 11, 2008.
3949 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
3950 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
3951 inheritance} for details.
3953 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
3959 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
3960 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
3961 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
3962 value. If you enclose the value into curly braces, it is interpreted as
3963 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
3966 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
3967 @section Property Inheritance
3968 @cindex properties, inheritance
3969 @cindex inheritance, of properties
3971 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself for an
3972 inheritance model of properties: If the parent in a tree has a certain
3973 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
3974 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
3975 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
3976 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
3977 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t}, to make
3978 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
3979 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
3980 inherited properties.
3982 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
3983 least for the special applications for which they are used:
3987 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
3988 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
3989 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
3990 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
3991 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
3993 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
3994 applies to the entire subtree.
3996 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
3997 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
3999 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4000 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4003 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4004 @section Column view
4006 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4007 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline item is turned into a
4008 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4009 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4010 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4011 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4012 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4013 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4014 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4015 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4016 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4017 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4018 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4021 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4022 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4023 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4026 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4027 @subsection Defining columns
4028 @cindex column view, for properties
4029 @cindex properties, column view
4031 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4032 done by defining a column format line.
4035 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4036 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4039 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4040 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4042 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4045 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4048 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4049 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4052 ** Top node for columns view
4054 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4058 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4059 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4060 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4061 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4062 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4063 deeper part of the tree.
4065 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4066 @subsubsection Column attributes
4067 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4068 definition looks like this:
4071 %[width]property[(title)][@{summary-type@}]
4075 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4076 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4079 width @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
4080 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
4081 property @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
4082 (title) @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the}
4083 @r{property name is used.}
4084 @{summary-type@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
4085 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4086 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4087 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4088 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4089 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4090 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM:SS, plain numbers are hours.}
4091 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, [X] if all children are [X].}
4092 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, [n/m].}
4093 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, [n%].}
4097 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4101 :COLUMNS: %20ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line - it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
4102 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4103 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4104 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4105 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4108 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
4109 item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
4110 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4111 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4112 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4113 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4114 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4115 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4116 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
4117 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4118 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
4119 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4120 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4123 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4124 @subsection Using column view
4127 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4130 Create the column view for the local environment. This command searches
4131 the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that defines
4132 a format. When one is found, the column view table is established for
4133 the entire tree, starting from the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
4134 property. If none is found, the format is taken from the @code{#+COLUMNS}
4135 line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format}, and column
4136 view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
4139 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
4146 @tsubheading{Editing values}
4147 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
4148 Move through the column view from field to field.
4149 @kindex S-@key{left}
4150 @kindex S-@key{right}
4151 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4152 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
4153 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
4155 Directly select the nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
4159 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
4162 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
4163 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
4164 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
4165 or fast selection interface will pop up.
4168 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
4171 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
4172 the column is smaller than that of the value.
4175 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
4176 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
4177 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
4178 current column view.
4179 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
4183 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
4184 @kindex S-M-@key{right}
4185 @item S-M-@key{right}
4186 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
4187 @kindex S-M-@key{left}
4188 @item S-M-@key{left}
4189 Delete the current column.
4192 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
4193 @subsection Capturing column view
4195 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
4196 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
4197 this @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
4198 of this block looks like this:
4200 @cindex #+BEGIN: columnview
4203 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
4208 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
4212 This is most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
4213 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
4214 in a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
4215 capture, you can use 3 values:
4217 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
4218 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
4220 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
4221 "ID" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
4222 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
4223 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
4224 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
4227 When @code{t}, insert a hline after every line. When a number N, insert
4228 a hline before each headline with level @code{<= N}.
4230 When set to @code{t}, enforce column groups to get vertical lines.
4232 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
4233 @item :skip-empty-rows
4234 When set to @code{t}, skip row where the only non-empty specifier of the
4235 column view is @code{ITEM}.
4240 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
4245 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
4246 for the scope or id of the view.
4251 Update dynamical block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
4252 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
4253 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
4254 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
4255 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
4256 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
4259 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
4260 instructions in front of the table - these will survive an update of the
4261 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
4262 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
4264 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
4265 @section The Property API
4266 @cindex properties, API
4267 @cindex API, for properties
4269 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
4270 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
4271 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
4274 @node Dates and Times, Capture, Properties and Columns, Top
4275 @chapter Dates and Times
4281 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
4282 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
4283 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
4284 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
4285 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
4286 is used in a much wider sense.
4289 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
4290 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
4291 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
4292 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
4293 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
4294 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
4298 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
4299 @section Timestamps, deadlines and scheduling
4301 @cindex ranges, time
4306 A time stamp is a specification of a date (possibly with time or a range
4307 of times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
4308 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
4309 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is the standard ISO date/time format. To
4310 use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A time stamp
4311 can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry. Its
4312 presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
4313 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
4316 @item Plain time stamp; Event; Appointment
4318 A simple time stamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
4319 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
4320 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
4321 plain time stamp will be shown exactly on that date.
4324 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
4325 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
4328 @item Time stamp with repeater interval
4329 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
4330 A time stamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
4331 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
4332 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months(m), or years(y). The
4333 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
4336 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
4339 @item Diary-style sexp entries
4340 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the
4341 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
4342 package. For example
4345 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
4346 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
4349 @item Time/Date range
4352 Two time stamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
4353 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
4354 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
4357 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
4358 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
4361 @item Inactive time stamp
4362 @cindex timestamp, inactive
4363 @cindex inactive timestamp
4364 Just like a plain time stamp, but with square brackets instead of
4365 angular ones. These time stamps are inactive in the sense that they do
4366 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
4369 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
4374 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
4375 @section Creating timestamps
4376 @cindex creating timestamps
4377 @cindex timestamps, creating
4379 For Org mode to recognize time stamps, they need to be in the specific
4380 format. All commands listed below produce time stamps in the correct
4386 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding time stamp. When the cursor is
4387 at an existing time stamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
4388 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
4389 succession, a time range is inserted.
4393 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but use the alternative format which contains date
4394 and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5 minutes,
4395 see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
4399 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive time stamp that will not cause
4404 Insert a time stamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
4408 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
4409 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
4414 Access the agenda for the date given by the time stamp or -range at
4415 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
4417 @kindex S-@key{left}
4418 @kindex S-@key{right}
4420 @itemx S-@key{right}
4421 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
4422 CUA mode (@pxref{Conflicts}).
4425 @kindex S-@key{down}
4428 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
4429 year, month, day, hour or minute. Note that if the cursor is in a
4430 headline and not at a time stamp, these same keys modify the priority of
4431 an item. (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with
4432 CUA mode (@pxref{Conflicts}).
4435 @cindex evaluate time range
4437 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
4438 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
4439 the following column).
4444 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
4445 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
4448 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
4449 @subsection The date/time prompt
4450 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
4451 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
4453 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown as an ISO
4454 date, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for an ISO date. But it
4455 will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or time
4456 information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
4457 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
4458 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information
4459 is in there and derive anything you have not specified from the
4460 @emph{default date and time}. The default is usually the current date
4461 and time, but when modifying an existing time stamp, or when entering
4462 the second stamp of a range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer.
4463 When filling in information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you
4464 will want to enter a date in the future: If you omit the month/year and
4465 the given day/month is @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a
4466 future date@footnote{See the variable
4467 @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}.}.
4469 For example, lets assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
4470 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
4474 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
4475 14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
4476 12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
4477 Fri --> nearest Friday (defaultdate or later)
4478 sep 15 --> @b{2006}-11-15
4479 feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
4480 sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
4481 12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
4482 22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
4483 w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
4484 2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
4485 2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
4488 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
4489 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
4490 letter [dwmy] to indicate change in days weeks, months, years. With a
4491 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
4492 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
4493 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
4494 the nth such day. E.g.
4499 +4d --> four days from today
4500 +4 --> same as above
4501 +2w --> two weeks from today
4502 ++5 --> five days from default date
4503 +2tue --> second tuesday from now.
4506 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
4507 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
4508 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
4510 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
4511 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
4512 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
4513 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
4514 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
4515 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
4516 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
4517 from the minibuffer:
4522 @kindex S-@key{right}
4523 @kindex S-@key{left}
4524 @kindex S-@key{down}
4526 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
4527 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
4530 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
4531 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
4532 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
4533 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
4534 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
4535 @key{RET} @r{Choose date in calendar.}
4538 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
4539 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
4540 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
4541 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
4542 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
4543 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
4545 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
4546 @subsection Custom time format
4547 @cindex custom date/time format
4548 @cindex time format, custom
4549 @cindex date format, custom
4551 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
4552 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
4553 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
4554 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
4555 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
4560 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
4564 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
4565 format does not @emph{replace} the default format - instead it is put
4566 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
4567 following consequences:
4570 You cannot place the cursor onto a time stamp anymore, only before or
4573 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
4574 each component of a time stamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
4575 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
4576 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
4577 time will be changed by one minute.
4579 If the time stamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
4580 will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were.
4582 When you delete a time stamp character-by-character, it will only
4583 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
4584 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
4586 If the custom time stamp format is longer than the default and you are
4587 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
4588 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
4592 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
4593 @section Deadlines and scheduling
4595 A time stamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
4599 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
4601 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
4602 to be finished on that date.
4604 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
4605 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
4606 approaching or missed deadline, starting
4607 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
4608 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
4611 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
4612 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
4613 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
4616 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
4617 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
4618 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
4621 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
4623 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
4626 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
4627 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
4628 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
4629 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
4630 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE.
4631 I.e., the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
4634 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
4635 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
4639 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
4640 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
4641 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
4642 mark this entry with a simple plain time stamp, to get this item shown
4643 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent mis-understanding from
4644 Org-users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
4645 want to start working on an action item.
4648 You may use time stamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
4649 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
4650 assumption that the time stamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
4651 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
4653 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
4655 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
4656 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
4657 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
4661 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
4662 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
4665 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
4666 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
4668 The following commands allow to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
4675 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
4676 happen in the line directly following the headline. When called with a
4677 prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed from the entry.
4678 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
4681 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
4683 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
4684 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
4685 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
4686 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
4687 all deadlines due tomorrow.
4691 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
4692 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED
4693 timestamp will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove
4694 the scheduling date from the entry.
4700 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
4701 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
4702 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
4703 schedule the marked item.
4706 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
4707 @subsection Repeated tasks
4709 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
4710 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
4711 or plain time stamp. In the following example
4713 ** TODO Pay the rent
4714 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
4716 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the
4717 task has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month
4718 starting from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special
4719 warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater comes first and the
4720 warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
4722 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they
4723 are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as
4724 completed once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE
4725 with the TODO keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the
4726 agenda. The problem with this is, however, that then also the
4727 @emph{next} instance of the repeated entry will not be active. Org mode
4728 deals with this in the following way: When you try to mark such an entry
4729 DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will shift the base date of the repeating
4730 time stamp by the repeater interval, and immediately set the entry state
4731 back to TODO. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would
4732 actually switch the date like this:
4735 ** TODO Pay the rent
4736 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
4739 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
4740 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
4741 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
4742 will aslo be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
4743 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
4745 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
4746 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
4749 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
4750 month. So if you have not payed the rent for three months, marking this
4751 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
4752 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
4753 forgot to call you father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
4754 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
4755 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
4756 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
4757 special repeaters markers with @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
4761 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
4762 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
4763 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
4764 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
4765 and marked it done on Saturday.
4766 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
4767 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
4768 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
4772 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
4773 task - just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
4775 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
4776 @section Clocking work time
4778 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spent on specific tasks in a
4779 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
4780 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
4781 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
4782 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project.
4787 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
4788 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
4789 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
4790 @code{:CLOCK:} drawer (see also the variable
4791 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
4792 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
4793 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
4794 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
4795 with letter @kbd{d}.
4798 Stop the clock (clock-out). The inserts another timestamp at the same
4799 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
4800 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
4801 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
4802 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
4803 time stamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
4804 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
4807 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the time stamps. This
4808 is only necessary if you edit the time stamps directly. If you change
4809 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
4812 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
4813 if it is running in this same item.
4816 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
4817 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
4820 Jump to the entry that contains the currently running clock. With a
4821 @kbd{C-u} prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked
4825 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
4826 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
4827 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
4828 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
4829 when you change the buffer (see variable
4830 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
4833 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
4834 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
4835 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
4836 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
4838 @cindex #+BEGIN: clocktable
4840 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
4844 If such a block already exists at point, its content is replaced by the
4845 new table. The @samp{BEGIN} line can specify options:
4847 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
4848 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items}
4849 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
4850 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
4851 file @r{the full current buffer}
4852 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
4853 treeN @r{the surrounding level N tree, for example @code{tree3}}
4854 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
4855 agenda @r{all agenda files}
4856 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
4857 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
4858 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
4859 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
4860 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
4862 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
4863 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
4864 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
4865 2007 @r{the year 2007}
4866 today, yesterday, today-N @r{a relative day}
4867 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-N @r{a relative week}
4868 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-N @r{a relative month}
4869 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-N @r{a relative year}
4870 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
4871 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times}
4872 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times}
4873 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
4874 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
4875 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins}
4876 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
4877 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds column with % time.}
4878 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
4879 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
4881 So to get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
4882 day, you could write
4884 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
4887 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
4888 parameters must be specified in a single line - the line is broken here
4889 only to fit it onto the manual.}
4891 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
4892 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
4895 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
4897 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
4904 Update dynamical block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
4905 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
4906 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
4907 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
4908 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
4909 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
4910 @kindex S-@key{left}
4911 @kindex S-@key{right}
4913 @itemx S-@key{right}
4914 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
4915 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
4916 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
4919 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
4920 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
4921 worked on or closed during a day.
4923 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
4924 @section Effort estimates
4925 @cindex effort estimates
4927 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
4928 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
4929 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
4930 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
4931 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
4932 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
4933 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. Clearly the best way to
4934 work with effort estimates is through column view (@pxref{Column view}). You
4935 should start by setting up discrete values for effort estimates, and a
4936 @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values together with clock sums (if
4937 you want to clock your time). For a specific buffer you can use
4940 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
4941 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4945 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
4946 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
4947 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
4948 setup may be advised.
4950 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
4951 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
4952 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
4953 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
4955 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
4956 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
4957 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
4958 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
4959 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
4960 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
4961 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
4962 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
4964 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
4965 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
4966 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
4967 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
4969 @node Relative timer, , Effort estimates, Dates and Times
4970 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
4971 @cindex relative timer
4973 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
4974 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
4975 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
4980 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
4981 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
4985 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
4986 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
4989 One the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
4993 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
4994 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
4995 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
4996 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
4997 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
4998 prefix argument @kbd{C-c C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
4999 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
5000 not started at exactly the right moment.
5003 @node Capture, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
5007 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
5008 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
5009 Org uses the @file{remember} package to create tasks, and stores files
5010 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory.
5013 * Remember:: Capture new tasks/ideas with little interruption
5014 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks.
5017 @node Remember, Attachments, Capture, Capture
5019 @cindex @file{remember.el}
5021 The @i{Remember} package by John Wiegley lets you store quick notes with
5022 little interruption of your work flow. See
5023 @uref{http://www.emacswiki.org/cgi-bin/wiki/RememberMode} for more
5024 information. It is an excellent way to add new notes and tasks to
5025 Org files. Org significantly expands the possibilities of
5026 @i{remember}: You may define templates for different note types, and
5027 associate target files and headlines with specific templates. It also
5028 allows you to select the location where a note should be stored
5029 interactively, on the fly.
5032 * Setting up Remember:: Some code for .emacs to get things going
5033 * Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types
5034 * Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs
5035 * Refiling notes:: Moving a note or task to a project
5038 @node Setting up Remember, Remember templates, Remember, Remember
5039 @subsection Setting up Remember
5041 The following customization will tell @i{remember} to use org files as
5042 target, and to create annotations compatible with Org links.
5045 (org-remember-insinuate)
5046 (setq org-directory "~/path/to/my/orgfiles/")
5047 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
5048 (define-key global-map "\C-cr" 'org-remember)
5051 The last line binds the command @code{org-remember} to a global
5052 key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c r} is only a
5053 suggestion.}. @code{org-remember} basically just calls @code{remember},
5054 but it makes a few things easier: If there is an active region, it will
5055 automatically copy the region into the remember buffer. It also allows
5056 to jump to the buffer and location where remember notes are being
5057 stored: Just call @code{org-remember} with a prefix argument. If you
5058 use two prefix arguments, Org jumps to the location where the last
5059 remember note was stored.
5061 The remember buffer will actually use @code{org-mode} as its major mode, so
5062 that all editing features of Org-mode are available. In addition to this, a
5063 minor mode @code{org-remember-mode} is turned on, for the single purpose that
5064 you can use its keymap @code{org-remember-mode-map} to overwrite some of
5065 Org-mode's key bindings.
5067 You can also call @code{org-remember} in a special way from the agenda,
5068 using the @kbd{k r} key combination. With this access, any time stamps
5069 inserted by the selected remember template (see below) will default to
5070 the cursor date in the agenda, rather than to the current date.
5072 @node Remember templates, Storing notes, Setting up Remember, Remember
5073 @subsection Remember templates
5074 @cindex templates, for remember
5076 In combination with Org, you can use templates to generate
5077 different types of @i{remember} notes. For example, if you would like
5078 to use one template to create general TODO entries, another one for
5079 journal entries, and a third one for collecting random ideas, you could
5083 (setq org-remember-templates
5084 '(("Todo" ?t "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/TODO.org" "Tasks")
5085 ("Journal" ?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org")
5086 ("Idea" ?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas")))
5089 @noindent In these entries, the first string is just a name, and the
5090 character specifies how to select the template. It is useful if the
5091 character is also the first letter of the name. The next string specifies
5092 the template. Two more (optional) strings give the file in which, and the
5093 headline under which the new note should be stored. The file (if not present
5094 or @code{nil}) defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}, the heading to
5095 @code{org-remember-default-headline}. If the file name is not an absolute
5096 path, it will be interpreted relative to @code{org-directory}. The heading
5097 can also be the symbols @code{top} or @code{bottom} to send note as level 1
5098 entries to the beginning or end of the file, respectively.
5100 An optional sixth element specifies the contexts in which the user can select
5101 the template. This element can be a list of major modes or a function.
5102 @code{org-remember} will first check whether the function returns @code{t} or
5103 if we are in any of the listed major mode, and exclude templates fo which
5104 this condition is not fulfilled. Templates that do not specify this element
5105 at all, or that use @code{nil} or @code{t} as a value will always be
5111 (setq org-remember-templates
5112 '(("Bug" ?b "* BUG %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/BUGS.org" "Bugs" (emacs-lisp-mode))
5113 ("Journal" ?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "X" my-check)
5114 ("Idea" ?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas")))
5117 The first template will only be available when invoking @code{org-remember}
5118 from an buffer in @code{emacs-lisp-mode}. The second template will only be
5119 available when the function @code{my-check} returns @code{t}. The third
5120 template will be proposed in any context.
5122 When you call @kbd{M-x org-remember} (or @kbd{M-x remember}) to remember
5123 something, Org will prompt for a key to select the template (if you have
5124 more than one template) and then prepare the buffer like
5127 [[file:link to where you called remember]]
5131 During expansion of the template, special @kbd{%}-escapes allow dynamic
5132 insertion of content:
5134 %^@{prompt@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
5135 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
5136 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
5137 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
5138 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
5139 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
5140 %i @r{initial content, the region when remember is called with C-u.}
5141 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
5142 %t @r{time stamp, date only}
5143 %T @r{time stamp with date and time}
5144 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive time stamps}
5145 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
5146 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
5147 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
5148 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
5149 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
5150 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
5151 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
5152 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
5153 %k @r{title of currently clocked task}
5154 %K @r{link to currently clocked task}
5155 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
5156 %^@{prop@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @code{prop}}
5157 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
5158 %[pathname] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @code{pathname}}
5159 %(sexp) @r{evaluate elisp @code{(sexp)} and replace with the result}
5160 %! @r{immediately store note after completing the template}
5161 @r{(skipping the @kbd{C-c C-c} that normally triggers storing)}
5162 %& @r{jump to target location immediately after storing note}
5166 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
5167 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
5168 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
5169 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in remember templates in a
5173 Link type | Available keywords
5174 -------------------+----------------------------------------------
5175 bbdb | %:name %:company
5176 bbdb | %::server %:port %:nick
5177 vm, wl, mh, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
5178 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
5179 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
5180 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
5181 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
5183 info | %:file %:node
5188 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
5191 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
5195 If you change your mind about which template to use, call
5196 @code{org-remember} in the remember buffer. You may then select a new
5197 template that will be filled with the previous context information.
5199 @node Storing notes, Refiling notes, Remember templates, Remember
5200 @subsection Storing notes
5202 When you are finished preparing a note with @i{remember}, you have to press
5203 @kbd{C-c C-c} to file the note away. If you have started the clock in the
5204 remember buffer, you will first be asked if you want to clock out
5205 now@footnote{To avoid this query, configure the variable
5206 @code{org-remember-clock-out-on-exit}.}. If you answer @kbd{n}, the clock
5207 will continue to run after the note was filed away.
5209 The handler will then store the note in the file and under the headline
5210 specified in the template, or it will use the default file and headlines.
5211 The window configuration will be restored, sending you back to the working
5212 context before the call to @code{remember}. To re-use the location found
5213 during the last call to @code{remember}, exit the remember buffer with
5214 @kbd{C-0 C-c C-c}, i.e. specify a zero prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5215 Another special case is @kbd{C-2 C-c C-c} which files the note as a child of
5216 the currently clocked item.
5218 If you want to store the note directly to a different place, use
5219 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-c} instead to exit remember@footnote{Configure the
5220 variable @code{org-remember-store-without-prompt} to make this behavior
5221 the default.}. The handler will then first prompt for a target file -
5222 if you press @key{RET}, the value specified for the template is used.
5223 Then the command offers the headings tree of the selected file, with the
5224 cursor position at the default headline (if you had specified one in the
5225 template). You can either immediately press @key{RET} to get the note
5226 placed there. Or you can use the following keys to find a different
5229 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
5230 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
5231 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
5232 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
5234 @c 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
5237 Pressing @key{RET} or @key{left} or @key{right}
5238 then leads to the following result.
5240 @multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.15 0.65
5241 @item @b{Cursor position} @tab @b{Key} @tab @b{Note gets inserted}
5242 @item on headline @tab @key{RET} @tab as sublevel of the heading at cursor, first or last
5243 @item @tab @tab depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}.
5244 @item @tab @key{left}/@key{right} @tab as same level, before/after current heading
5245 @item buffer-start @tab @key{RET} @tab as level 2 heading at end of file or level 1 at beginning
5246 @item @tab @tab depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}.
5247 @item not on headline @tab @key{RET}
5248 @tab at cursor position, level taken from context.
5251 Before inserting the text into a tree, the function ensures that the text has
5252 a headline, i.e. a first line that starts with a @samp{*}. If not, a
5253 headline is constructed from the current date. If you have indented the text
5254 of the note below the headline, the indentation will be adapted if inserting
5255 the note into the tree requires demotion from level 1.
5257 @node Refiling notes, , Storing notes, Remember
5258 @subsection Refiling notes
5259 @cindex refiling notes
5261 Remember is usually used to quickly capture notes and tasks into one or
5262 a few capture lists. When reviewing the captured data, you may want to
5263 refile some of the entries into a different list, for example into a
5264 project. Cutting, finding the right location and then pasting the note
5265 is cumbersome. To simplify this process, you can use the following
5271 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
5272 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
5273 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
5274 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
5276 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
5277 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
5278 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
5279 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
5280 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
5281 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}.
5284 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
5285 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-w
5286 @item C-u C-u C-c C-w
5287 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
5290 @node Attachments, , Remember, Capture
5291 @section Attachments
5294 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
5295 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
5296 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can be used to establish associations with
5297 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
5298 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
5299 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
5300 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
5301 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
5302 your org-file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org-files from one
5303 directory to the next, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
5304 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
5305 @code{git-init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
5306 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
5308 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments.
5314 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
5315 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you need to press an additional key
5316 to select a command:
5321 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
5322 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
5323 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
5329 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
5330 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
5334 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
5338 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
5339 attachments yourself.
5343 Open current task's attachment. If there are more than one, prompt for a
5344 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
5345 For more details, see the information on following hyperlings
5346 (@pxref{Handling links}).
5350 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
5354 Open the current task's attachment directory.
5358 Also open the directory, but force using @code{dired} in Emacs.
5362 Select and delete a single attachment.
5366 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
5367 dired and delete from there.
5371 @node Agenda Views, Embedded LaTeX, Capture, Top
5372 @chapter Agenda Views
5373 @cindex agenda views
5375 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
5376 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
5377 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
5378 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
5379 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
5381 Org can select items based on various criteria, and display them
5382 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
5386 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
5389 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
5392 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties and
5393 TODO state associated with them,
5395 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
5396 in time-sorted view,
5398 a @emph{keyword search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
5399 that contain specified keywords.
5401 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
5404 @emph{custom views} that are special tag/keyword searches and
5405 combinations of different views.
5409 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
5410 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
5411 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
5412 edit these files remotely.
5414 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
5415 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
5416 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
5417 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
5420 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
5421 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
5422 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
5423 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
5424 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
5425 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
5426 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
5429 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
5430 @section Agenda files
5431 @cindex agenda files
5432 @cindex files for agenda
5434 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
5435 files}, the files listed in the variable
5436 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
5437 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
5438 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
5439 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
5442 Thus even if you only work with a single Org file, this file should
5443 be put into that list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
5444 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
5445 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
5446 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
5447 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
5449 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
5453 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
5454 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
5455 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
5458 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
5463 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
5464 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
5465 @item M-x org-iswitchb
5466 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
5471 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
5472 to visit any of them.
5474 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily onto a file not in
5475 this list, or onto just one file in the list or even only a subtree in a
5476 file, this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
5477 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
5478 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
5479 extended period, use the following commands:
5484 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
5485 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
5486 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
5487 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
5488 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
5489 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
5492 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
5496 When working with @file{Speedbar}, you can use the following commands in
5500 @item < @r{in the speedbar frame}
5501 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item at the cursor in the
5502 Speedbar frame, either an Org file or a subtree in such a file.
5503 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
5506 @item > @r{in the speedbar frame}
5507 Lift the restriction again.
5510 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
5511 @section The agenda dispatcher
5512 @cindex agenda dispatcher
5513 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
5514 The views are created through a dispatcher that should be bound to a
5515 global key, for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
5516 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
5517 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
5518 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
5519 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
5522 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5524 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
5526 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
5527 tags and properties}).
5529 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
5531 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
5532 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
5534 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
5535 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-multi-occur-extra-files}. This
5536 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
5537 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
5540 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
5542 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
5543 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
5544 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
5545 selecting the command.
5547 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
5548 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
5549 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
5550 current buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
5551 character selecting the command.
5554 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
5555 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
5556 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
5557 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
5558 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
5560 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
5561 @section The built-in agenda views
5563 In this section we describe the built-in views.
5566 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
5567 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
5568 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
5569 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
5570 * Keyword search:: Finding entries by keyword
5571 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
5574 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
5575 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
5577 @cindex weekly agenda
5578 @cindex daily agenda
5580 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
5581 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
5584 @cindex org-agenda, command
5587 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of org files. The agenda
5588 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
5589 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
5590 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
5591 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
5592 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed (see also the
5593 variable @code{org-agenda-ndays})
5596 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
5597 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
5598 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
5601 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
5602 @cindex calendar integration
5603 @cindex diary integration
5605 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
5606 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
5607 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
5608 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
5609 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
5610 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
5613 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
5614 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
5617 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
5620 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
5621 entries including holidays, anniversaries etc will be included in the
5622 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
5623 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
5624 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
5625 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
5626 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
5627 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
5628 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
5629 between calendar and agenda.
5631 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
5632 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
5633 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
5634 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
5635 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
5636 the left margin, no white space is allowed before them. For example,
5637 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
5638 will be made in the agenda:
5641 * Birthdays and similar stuff
5643 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
5645 %%(diary-anniversary 14 5 1956) Arthur Dent is %d years old
5646 %%(diary-anniversary 2 10 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
5649 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
5650 @cindex @file{appt.el}
5651 @cindex appointment reminders
5653 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility.
5655 To add all the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
5656 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This commands also lets you filter through
5657 the list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific
5658 category or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for
5661 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
5662 @subsection The global TODO list
5663 @cindex global TODO list
5664 @cindex TODO list, global
5666 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items, formatted and
5667 collected into a single place.
5672 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all
5673 agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The buffer is in
5674 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate
5675 the TODO entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
5678 @cindex TODO keyword matching
5679 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You
5680 can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. With
5681 a @kbd{C-u} prefix you are prompted for a keyword, and you may also
5682 specify several keywords by separating them with @samp{|} as boolean OR
5683 operator. With a numeric prefix, the Nth keyword in
5684 @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
5686 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
5687 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
5688 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
5689 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
5690 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
5691 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5694 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
5695 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
5696 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
5698 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
5699 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
5700 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
5704 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for
5705 execution (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}. Configure the
5706 variable @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled} to exclude scheduled
5707 items from the global TODO list.
5709 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
5710 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
5711 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
5712 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
5715 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
5716 @subsection Matching tags and properties
5717 @cindex matching, of tags
5718 @cindex matching, of properties
5722 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags}
5723 (@pxref{Tags}), you can select headlines based on the tags that apply
5724 to them and collect them into an agenda buffer.
5729 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
5730 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
5731 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
5732 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
5733 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
5736 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items
5737 and force checking subitems (see variable
5738 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). Matching specific TODO keywords
5739 together with a tags match is also possible, see @ref{Tag searches}.
5742 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
5745 @node Timeline, Keyword search, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
5746 @subsection Timeline for a single file
5747 @cindex timeline, single file
5748 @cindex time-sorted view
5750 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
5751 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
5752 to give an overview over events in a project.
5757 Show a time-sorted view of the org file, with all time-stamped items.
5758 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
5759 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
5763 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
5764 @ref{Agenda commands}.
5766 @node Keyword search, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
5767 @subsection Keyword search
5768 @cindex keyword search
5769 @cindex searching, for keywords
5771 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
5772 It is particularly useful to find notes.
5777 This is a special search that lets you select entries by keywords or
5778 regular expression, using a boolean logic. For example, the search
5782 +computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}
5786 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
5787 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
5788 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
5789 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g.
5791 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
5792 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
5795 @node Stuck projects, , Keyword search, Built-in agenda views
5796 @subsection Stuck projects
5798 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
5799 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
5800 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
5801 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
5802 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
5803 projects and define next actions for them.
5808 List projects that are stuck.
5811 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
5812 project is and how to find it.
5815 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
5816 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
5817 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
5818 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
5820 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
5821 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
5822 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
5823 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
5824 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
5825 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
5826 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
5827 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
5828 with a tags/todo match @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for
5829 TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that
5830 are not stuck. The correct customization for this is
5833 (setq org-stuck-projects
5834 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
5839 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
5840 @section Presentation and sorting
5841 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
5843 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares
5844 the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
5845 starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
5846 (@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
5847 customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
5848 The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
5849 associated with the item.
5852 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
5853 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
5854 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
5857 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
5858 @subsection Categories
5861 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
5862 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
5863 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
5864 backward compatibility, the following also works: If there are several
5865 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
5866 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
5867 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
5868 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
5869 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
5877 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
5878 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the location
5879 as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
5882 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
5883 longer than 10 characters.
5885 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
5886 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
5887 @cindex time-of-day specification
5889 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
5890 time can be part of the time stamp that triggered inclusion into the
5891 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
5892 ranges can be specified with two time stamps, like
5894 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
5896 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
5897 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
5898 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
5899 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
5901 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
5902 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
5903 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
5906 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
5907 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
5908 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
5909 20:30-22:15 Marwin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
5913 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
5914 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
5917 8:00...... ------------------
5918 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
5919 10:00...... ------------------
5920 12:00...... ------------------
5921 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
5922 14:00...... ------------------
5923 16:00...... ------------------
5924 18:00...... ------------------
5925 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
5926 20:00...... ------------------
5927 20:30-22:15 Marwin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
5930 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
5931 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
5932 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
5934 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
5935 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
5936 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
5937 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
5938 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
5939 done depends on the type of view.
5942 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
5943 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
5944 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
5945 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
5946 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
5947 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
5948 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
5949 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
5950 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
5952 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
5953 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
5954 (@pxref{Priorities}).
5956 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
5957 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
5960 Sorting can be customized using the variable
5961 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
5962 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
5964 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
5965 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
5966 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
5968 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the org file or diary
5969 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
5970 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
5971 original entry location, and to edit the org-files ``remotely'' from
5972 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
5973 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
5975 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
5976 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
5979 @tsubheading{Motion}
5980 @cindex motion commands in agenda
5983 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
5986 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
5987 @tsubheading{View/Go to org file}
5992 Display the original location of the item in another window.
5993 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
5994 outline, not only the heading.
5998 Display original location and recenter that window.
6006 Go to the original location of the item in another window. Under Emacs
6007 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also works for this.
6011 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
6015 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
6016 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
6017 location in the org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
6018 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
6019 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
6023 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
6024 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
6025 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
6026 previously used indirect buffer.
6030 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that where marked DONE while
6031 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
6032 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
6033 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
6034 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
6035 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
6036 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
6040 Toggle Archives mode. In archives mode, trees that are marked are also
6041 scanned when producing the agenda. When you call this command with a
6042 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, even all archive files are included. To exit
6043 archives mode, press @kbd{v} again.
6047 Toggle Clockreport mode. In clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
6048 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
6049 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
6050 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
6051 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}.
6053 @tsubheading{Change display}
6054 @cindex display changing, in agenda
6057 Delete other windows.
6064 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
6065 this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
6066 month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
6067 A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
6068 of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
6069 @kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
6070 setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
6071 argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
6072 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
6073 be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
6077 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
6081 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
6082 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
6086 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes
6087 after modification of the time stamps of items with S-@key{left} and
6088 S-@key{right}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
6089 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
6099 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session.
6103 Display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days. For example, if
6104 the display covers a week, switch to the following week. With prefix
6105 arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
6109 Display the previous dates.
6117 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
6118 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
6119 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
6120 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
6121 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
6122 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
6124 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
6125 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
6126 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
6127 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
6128 @cindex query editing, in agenda
6132 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
6133 The difference between this and a custom agenda commands is that filtering is
6134 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
6135 having to recreate the agenda.
6137 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter. Pressing @key{TAB} at that
6138 prompt will offer use completion to select a tag (including any tags that do
6139 not have a selection character). The command then hides all entries that do
6140 not contain or inherit this tag. When called with prefix arg, remove the
6141 entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second @kbd{/} at the prompt will
6142 turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries. If the first key you
6143 press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter will be narrowed by
6144 requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag. Instead of pressing
6145 @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also immediately use the @kbd{\}
6148 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set-up allowed
6149 efforts globally, for example
6151 (setq org-global-properties
6152 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
6154 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of @kbd{<},
6155 @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort estimate in
6156 your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value. The filter
6157 will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal, or
6158 larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used as
6159 fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit directly
6160 without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed.
6164 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
6165 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
6166 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
6167 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
6174 In the @i{search view} (@pxref{Keyword search}), these keys add new search
6175 words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions (@kbd{@{} and
6176 @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will add a positive
6177 search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search term @i{must}
6178 occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a negative
6179 search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
6183 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
6184 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
6189 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
6190 @cindex remote editing, undo
6193 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
6194 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
6198 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
6203 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
6204 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
6205 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
6206 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
6210 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
6214 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{Archive
6219 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
6220 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
6225 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
6226 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
6227 tags of a headline occasionally.
6231 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
6232 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
6236 Set the priority for the current item. Org mode prompts for the
6237 priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the priority cookie
6238 is removed from the entry.
6242 Display weighted priority of current item.
6248 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
6249 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
6253 @kindex S-@key{down}
6256 Decrease the priority of the current item.
6260 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
6268 Set a deadline for this item.
6272 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
6273 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
6276 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
6277 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
6278 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
6279 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
6280 r @r{Call @code{org-remember} with the cursor date as default date.}
6282 Press @kbd{r} afterwards to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
6285 @kindex S-@key{right}
6287 Change the time stamp associated with the current line by one day into the
6288 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
6289 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. The stamp is
6290 changed in the original org file, but the change is not directly reflected in
6291 the agenda buffer. Use the @kbd{r} key to update the buffer.
6293 @kindex S-@key{left}
6295 Change the time stamp associated with the current line by one day
6300 Change the time stamp associated with the current line to today.
6301 The key @kbd{>} has been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.}
6306 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
6311 Stop the previously started clock.
6315 Cancel the currently running clock.
6319 Jump to the running clock in another window.
6321 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
6322 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
6325 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
6328 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
6331 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
6334 Insert a new entry into the diary. Prompts for the type of entry
6335 (day, weekly, monthly, yearly, anniversary, cyclic) and creates a new
6336 entry in the diary, just as @kbd{i d} etc. would do in the calendar.
6337 The date is taken from the cursor position.
6341 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
6345 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
6346 with calendar variables, see documentation of the Emacs calendar.
6350 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
6355 Show holidays for three month around the cursor date.
6357 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
6358 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
6359 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
6361 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
6364 @cindex exporting agenda views
6365 @cindex agenda views, exporting
6366 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the
6367 selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension
6368 @file{.html} or @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), or
6369 plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
6370 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print}
6371 and for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
6373 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
6376 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
6379 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
6381 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
6382 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
6383 visit org files will not be removed.
6387 @node Custom agenda views, Agenda column view, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
6388 @section Custom agenda views
6389 @cindex custom agenda views
6390 @cindex agenda views, custom
6392 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
6393 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
6394 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
6395 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
6398 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
6399 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
6400 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
6401 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing agendas to files
6402 * Using the agenda elsewhere:: Using agenda information in other programs
6405 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
6406 @subsection Storing searches
6408 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
6409 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
6410 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
6413 Custom commands are configured in the variable
6414 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
6415 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
6416 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
6421 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6422 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
6423 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
6424 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
6425 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
6426 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
6427 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
6428 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
6429 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
6430 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
6431 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
6436 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
6437 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
6438 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
6439 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
6440 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
6441 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
6442 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
6443 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
6444 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
6449 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
6452 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
6453 results as a sparse tree
6455 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
6458 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
6459 headlines that are also TODO items
6461 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
6462 displaying the result as a sparse tree
6464 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
6465 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
6467 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
6468 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
6469 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
6472 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
6473 @subsection Block agenda
6474 @cindex block agenda
6475 @cindex agenda, with block views
6477 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
6478 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
6479 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
6480 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
6481 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
6482 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
6483 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
6487 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6488 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
6492 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
6500 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
6501 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
6502 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
6503 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
6504 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
6506 @node Setting Options, Exporting Agenda Views, Block agenda, Custom agenda views
6507 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
6508 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
6510 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
6511 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
6512 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
6513 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
6514 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
6515 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
6519 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6520 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
6521 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
6522 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
6523 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
6524 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
6525 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
6527 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
6528 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
6533 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
6534 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
6535 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
6536 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
6537 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
6538 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
6539 to only a single file.
6541 For command sets creating a block agenda,
6542 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
6543 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
6544 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
6545 the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter
6546 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
6547 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
6548 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
6549 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
6550 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
6554 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6555 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
6559 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
6560 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
6561 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
6568 As you see, the values and parenthesis setting is a little complex.
6569 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable - it
6570 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: When setting options in
6571 this interface, the @emph{values} are just lisp expressions. So if the
6572 value is a string, you need to add the double quotes around the value
6576 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Using the agenda elsewhere, Setting Options, Custom agenda views
6577 @subsection Exporting Agenda Views
6578 @cindex agenda views, exporting
6580 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a
6581 printed version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can
6582 export custom agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to
6583 install Hrvoje Niksic' @file{htmlize.el}.} postscript, and iCalendar
6584 files. If you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
6589 @cindex exporting agenda views
6590 @cindex agenda views, exporting
6591 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the
6592 selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension
6593 @file{.html} or @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}),
6594 iCalendar (extension @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension).
6595 Use the variable @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to
6596 set options for @file{ps-print} and for @file{htmlize} to be used during
6600 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
6601 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
6602 (ps-landscape-mode t)
6603 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
6607 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
6608 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
6609 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
6610 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
6611 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
6612 that first does define custom commands for the agenda and the global
6613 todo list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
6614 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
6615 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
6620 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6621 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
6622 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
6623 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
6628 ("~/views/home.html"))
6629 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
6634 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
6638 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
6639 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
6640 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
6641 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
6642 postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
6643 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
6644 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda now. Any other
6645 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
6647 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
6648 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
6649 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
6655 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
6659 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
6660 set options for the export commands. For example:
6663 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6665 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
6666 (ps-landscape-mode t)
6667 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
6668 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
6669 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
6674 This command sets two options for the postscript exporter, to make it
6675 print in two columns in landscape format - the resulting page can be cut
6676 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
6677 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
6678 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
6679 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
6680 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
6681 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
6682 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
6685 From the command line you may also use
6687 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
6690 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting may depend on the
6691 system you use, please check th FAQ for examples.}
6693 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
6694 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
6695 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
6696 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
6697 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
6701 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
6702 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with 30 days
6705 @node Using the agenda elsewhere, , Exporting Agenda Views, Custom agenda views
6706 @subsection Using agenda information outside of Org
6707 @cindex agenda, pipe
6708 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
6710 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
6711 line in emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
6712 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
6713 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
6714 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
6715 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
6716 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
6717 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
6718 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
6719 current TODO list, you could use
6722 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
6725 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
6726 tags/todo match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
6727 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
6728 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
6731 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
6732 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
6736 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
6739 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
6740 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
6741 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
6742 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
6743 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
6748 which will produce a 30 day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
6749 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
6751 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
6752 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
6753 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
6754 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
6758 category @r{The category of the item}
6759 head @r{The headline, without TODO kwd, TAGS and PRIORITY}
6760 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
6761 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
6762 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
6763 diary @r{imported from diary}
6764 deadline @r{a deadline}
6765 scheduled @r{scheduled}
6766 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
6767 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
6768 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
6769 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
6770 block @r{entry has date block including date}
6771 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
6772 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
6773 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
6774 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
6775 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
6776 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
6777 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
6781 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
6782 lead to the selection of the item.
6784 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post processing script.
6785 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
6786 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
6792 # define the Emacs command to run
6793 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
6795 # run it and capture the output
6796 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
6798 # loop over all lines
6799 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
6801 # get the individual values
6802 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
6803 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
6805 # proccess and print
6806 print "[ ] $head\n";
6811 @node Agenda column view, , Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
6812 @section Using column view in the agenda
6813 @cindex column view, in agenda
6814 @cindex agenda, column view
6816 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
6817 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
6818 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
6819 collected by certain criteria.
6824 Turn on column view in the agenda.
6827 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
6828 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
6829 This causes the following issues:
6833 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
6834 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
6835 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
6836 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
6837 currently set, and if yes takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
6838 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
6839 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in it's file), it
6840 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6842 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
6843 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
6844 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
6845 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
6846 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
6847 cover a single day, in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
6848 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
6849 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
6850 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and it's @emph{child}). In these
6851 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
6852 some values will count double.
6854 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
6855 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
6856 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
6857 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
6858 a column listing the planned total effort for a task - one of the major
6859 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
6860 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
6865 @node Embedded LaTeX, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
6866 @chapter Embedded LaTeX
6867 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
6868 @cindex La@TeX{} interpretation
6870 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One
6871 exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to contain
6872 mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{}
6873 is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the
6874 features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for
6875 simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset
6876 scientific documents. Org mode supports embedding La@TeX{} code into its
6877 files, because many academics are used to reading La@TeX{} source code, and
6878 because it can be readily processed into images for HTML production.
6880 It is not necessary to mark La@TeX{} macros and code in any special way.
6881 If you observe a few conventions, Org mode knows how to find it and what
6885 * Math symbols:: TeX macros for symbols and Greek letters
6886 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
6887 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
6888 * Processing LaTeX fragments:: Previewing LaTeX processing
6889 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
6892 @node Math symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
6893 @section Math symbols
6894 @cindex math symbols
6897 You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha}
6898 to indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow.
6899 Completion for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a
6900 few letters, and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions.
6901 Unlike La@TeX{} code, Org mode allows these macros to be present
6902 without surrounding math delimiters, for example:
6905 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
6908 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), these symbols are translated
6909 into the proper syntax for HTML, for the above examples this is
6910 @samp{α} and @samp{→}, respectively. If you need such a symbol
6911 inside a word, terminate it like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
6913 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Math symbols, Embedded LaTeX
6914 @section Subscripts and superscripts
6918 Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
6919 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
6920 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
6921 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
6922 with curly braces. For example
6925 The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
6926 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
6929 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote
6930 @samp{^} and @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\_} and @samp{\^}.
6932 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), subscript and superscripts
6933 are surrounded with @code{<sub>} and @code{<sup>} tags, respectively.
6935 @node LaTeX fragments, Processing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
6936 @section LaTeX fragments
6937 @cindex LaTeX fragments
6939 With symbols, sub- and superscripts, HTML is pretty much at its end when
6940 it comes to representing mathematical formulas@footnote{Yes, there is
6941 MathML, but that is not yet fully supported by many browsers, and there
6942 is no decent converter for turning La@TeX{} or ASCII representations of
6943 formulas into MathML. So for the time being, converting formulas into
6944 images seems the way to go.}. More complex expressions need a dedicated
6945 formula processor. To this end, Org mode can contain arbitrary La@TeX{}
6946 fragments. It provides commands to preview the typeset result of these
6947 fragments, and upon export to HTML, all fragments will be converted to
6948 images and inlined into the HTML document@footnote{The La@TeX{} export
6949 will not use images for displaying La@TeX{} fragments but include these
6950 fragments directly into the La@TeX{} code.}. For this to work you
6951 need to be on a system with a working La@TeX{} installation. You also
6952 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
6953 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that
6954 will be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the
6955 variable @code{org-format-latex-header}.
6957 La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
6958 snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code:
6961 Environments of any kind. The only requirement is that the
6962 @code{\begin} statement appears on a new line, preceded by only
6965 Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
6966 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized
6967 as math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks,
6968 is directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in
6969 between, and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace or
6970 punctuation. For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so
6971 when in doubt, use @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
6974 @noindent For example:
6977 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
6978 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
6979 \end@{equation@} % etc
6981 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
6982 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
6986 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
6987 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
6988 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter.
6990 @node Processing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
6991 @section Processing LaTeX fragments
6992 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
6994 La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to produce a preview images of the
6995 typeset expressions:
7000 Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
7001 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
7002 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
7003 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
7004 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
7005 process the entire buffer.
7008 Remove the overlay preview images.
7011 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), all La@TeX{} fragments are
7012 converted into images and inlined into the document if the following
7016 (setq org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments t)
7019 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Processing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
7020 @section Using CDLaTeX to enter math
7023 CDLaTeX mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
7024 major La@TeX{} mode like AUCTeX in order to speed-up insertion of
7025 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
7026 some of the features of CDLaTeX mode. You need to install
7027 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
7028 AUCTeX) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
7029 Don't use CDLaTeX mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
7030 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
7031 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
7035 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
7038 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
7039 details see the documentation of CDLaTeX mode):
7043 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
7046 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
7047 La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
7048 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
7049 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
7050 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
7051 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
7052 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
7053 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
7054 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
7055 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
7056 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
7060 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these
7061 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
7062 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
7063 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
7064 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
7067 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
7068 macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
7069 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
7072 Pressing the normal quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
7073 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
7074 1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character
7075 modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote
7079 @node Exporting, Publishing, Embedded LaTeX, Top
7083 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
7084 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and
7085 simple version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a
7086 notes file on the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for
7087 exchange with a broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets
7088 you use Org mode and its structured editing functions to easily create
7089 La@TeX{} files. To incorporate entries with associated times like
7090 deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like iCal,
7091 Org mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
7092 Org mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
7094 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
7095 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
7098 * Markup rules:: Which structures are recognized?
7099 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
7100 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
7101 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
7102 * ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII
7103 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
7104 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF
7105 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
7106 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
7109 @node Markup rules, Selective export, Exporting, Exporting
7110 @section Markup rules
7112 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
7113 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the back-end. Since
7114 export targets like HTML or La@TeX{} allow much richer formatting, Org mode
7115 has rules how to prepare text for rich export. This section summarizes the
7116 markup rule used in an Org mode buffer.
7119 * Document title:: How the document title is determined
7120 * Headings and sections:: The main structure of the exported document
7121 * Table of contents:: If, where, how to create a table of contents
7122 * Initial text:: Text before the first headline
7123 * Lists:: Plain lists are exported
7124 * Paragraphs:: What determines beginning and ending
7125 * Literal examples:: Source code and other examples
7126 * Include files:: Include the contents of a file during export
7127 * Tables exported:: Tables are exported richly
7128 * Inlined images:: How to inline images during export
7129 * Footnotes:: Numbers like [1]
7130 * Emphasis and monospace:: To bold or not to bold
7131 * TeX macros and LaTeX fragments:: Create special, rich export.
7132 * Horizontal rules:: A line across the page
7133 * Comment lines:: Some lines will not be exported
7136 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Markup rules, Markup rules
7137 @subheading Document title
7138 @cindex document title, markup rules
7141 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
7144 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
7148 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
7149 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
7150 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
7151 title will be the file name without extension.
7153 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
7154 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
7155 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
7157 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Markup rules
7158 @subheading Headings and sections
7159 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
7161 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
7162 Structure} forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
7163 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
7164 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
7165 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
7166 switch, globally by setting the variable @code{org-headline-levels}, or on a
7167 per file basis with a line
7173 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Markup rules
7174 @subheading Table of contents
7175 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
7177 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
7178 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
7179 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
7180 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
7181 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number or turn off
7182 the table of contents entirely by configuring the variable
7183 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
7186 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
7187 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
7190 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Markup rules
7191 @subheading Text before the first headline
7192 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
7195 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
7196 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
7197 you need to include literal HTML or La@TeX{} code, use the special constructs
7198 described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
7200 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
7201 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
7202 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
7203 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
7204 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
7207 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
7208 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
7212 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
7213 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
7214 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
7217 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Markup rules
7219 @cindex lists, markup rules
7221 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists} are translated to the back-ends
7222 syntax for such lists. Most back-ends support unordered, ordered, and
7225 @node Paragraphs, Literal examples, Lists, Markup rules
7226 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
7227 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
7229 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
7230 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
7232 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
7233 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
7237 Great clouds overhead
7238 Tiny black birds rise and fall
7245 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
7246 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
7247 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
7251 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
7252 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
7257 @node Literal examples, Include files, Paragraphs, Markup rules
7258 @subheading Literal examples
7259 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
7260 @cindex code line refenences, markup rules
7262 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
7263 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
7264 for source code and similar examples.
7265 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
7269 Some example from a text file.
7273 For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the example
7277 : Some example from a text file.
7280 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
7281 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
7282 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
7283 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{Currently this works only for
7284 the HTML back-end, and requires the @file{htmlize.el} package version 1.34 or
7285 later.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to
7286 specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
7291 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
7292 (defun org-xor (a b)
7298 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
7299 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
7300 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
7301 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
7302 Org will interpret strings like @samp{((name))} as labels, and use them as
7303 targets for hyperlinks like @code{[[((name))]]}. In HTML, hoovering the
7304 mouse over such a link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line,
7305 which is kind of cool. If the example/src snippet is numbered, you can also
7306 add a @code{-r} switch. Then labels will be @i{removed} from the source code
7307 and the links will be @i{replaced}@footnote{If you want to explain the use of
7308 such labels themelves in an example, you can use the @code{-k} switch to make
7309 sure they are not touched.} with line numbers from the code listing. Here is
7313 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
7315 (goto-char (point-min)) ((jump))
7317 In [[((jump))][line ((jump))]] we go to .....
7323 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
7324 switching to an indirect buffer, narrowing the buffer and switching to the
7325 other mode. You need to exit by pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon
7326 exit, lines starting with @samp{*} or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to
7327 keep them from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special
7328 comments. These commas will be striped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and
7329 also for export.}. Fixed-width
7330 regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be
7331 edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with
7332 the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating
7333 ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
7337 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
7338 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label, make sure
7339 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it as @samp{((label))} at
7340 the end of the current line. Then the label is stored as a link, for
7341 retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
7344 @node Include files, Tables exported, Literal examples, Markup rules
7345 @subheading Include files
7346 @cindex include files, markup rules
7348 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
7349 include your .emacs file, you could use:
7353 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
7356 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (@samp{quote},
7357 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
7358 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional, if it is not
7359 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
7360 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
7361 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
7362 first line and for each following line. For example, to include a file as an
7366 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
7372 Visit the include file at point.
7375 @node Tables exported, Inlined images, Include files, Markup rules
7377 @cindex tables, markup rules
7379 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
7380 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
7381 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
7382 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to asssign
7383 a caption and a label for cross references:
7386 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
7387 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
7390 @node Inlined images, Footnotes, Tables exported, Markup rules
7391 @subheading Inlined Images
7392 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
7394 Some backends (HTML and LaTeX) allow to directly include images into the
7395 exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image files does not have
7396 a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}. If you wish to
7397 define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal cross
7398 references, you can use (before, but close to the link)
7401 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
7402 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
7405 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
7406 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
7409 @node Footnotes, Emphasis and monospace, Inlined images, Markup rules
7410 @subheading Footnotes
7411 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
7412 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
7415 Numbers in square brackets are treated as footnote markers, and lines
7416 starting with such a marker are interpreted as the footnote itself. You can
7417 use the Emacs package @file{footnote.el} to create footnotes@footnote{The
7418 @file{footnote} package uses @kbd{C-c !} to invoke its commands. This
7419 binding conflicts with the Org mode command for inserting inactive time
7420 stamps. You could use the variable @code{footnote-prefix} to switch
7421 footnotes commands to another key. Or, if you are too used to this binding,
7422 you could use @code{org-replace-disputed-keys} and @code{org-disputed-keys}
7423 to change the settings in Org.}. For example:
7426 The Org homepage[1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
7428 [1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
7431 @node Emphasis and monospace, TeX macros and LaTeX fragments, Footnotes, Markup rules
7432 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
7434 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
7435 @cindex bold text, markup rules
7436 @cindex italic text, markup rules
7437 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
7438 @cindex code text, markup rules
7439 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
7440 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
7441 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
7442 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
7443 syntax, it is exported verbatim.
7445 @node TeX macros and LaTeX fragments, Horizontal rules, Emphasis and monospace, Markup rules
7446 @subheading @TeX{} macros and La@TeX{} fragments
7447 @cindex LaTeX fragments, markup rules
7448 @cindex TeX macros, markup rules
7449 @cindex HTML entities
7450 @cindex LaTeX entities
7452 A @TeX{}-like syntax is used to specify special characters. Where possible,
7453 these will be transformed into the native format of the exporter back-end.
7454 Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as @code{α} in the HTML
7455 output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the La@TeX{} output. Similarly,
7456 @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and @code{~} in La@TeX{}.
7457 This applies for a large number of entities, with names taken from both HTML
7458 and La@TeX{}, see the variable @code{org-html-entities} for the complete
7459 list. If you are unsure about a name, use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} for completion
7460 after having types the backslash and maybe a few characters
7461 (@pxref{Completion}).
7463 La@TeX{} fragments are converted into images for HTML export, and they are
7464 written literally into the La@TeX{} export. See also @ref{Embedded LaTeX}.
7466 Finally, @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
7467 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
7468 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
7470 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, TeX macros and LaTeX fragments, Markup rules
7471 @subheading Horizontal rules
7472 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
7473 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
7474 exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
7476 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Markup rules
7477 @subheading Comment lines
7478 @cindex comment lines
7479 @cindex exporting, not
7481 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
7482 never be exported. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
7483 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
7484 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
7489 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
7492 @node Selective export, Export options, Markup rules, Exporting
7493 @section Selective export
7494 @cindex export, selective by tags
7496 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
7497 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
7498 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
7500 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
7501 If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
7502 selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
7503 selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
7506 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
7510 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
7511 be removed from the export buffer.
7513 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
7514 @section Export options
7515 @cindex options, for export
7517 @cindex completion, of option keywords
7518 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
7519 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
7520 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
7521 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
7522 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
7523 (@pxref{Completion}).
7528 Insert template with export options, see example below.
7539 @cindex #+LINK_HOME:
7540 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:
7541 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
7543 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
7544 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
7545 #+DATE: A date, fixed, of a format string for @code{format-time-string}
7546 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
7547 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
7548 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
7549 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
7550 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
7551 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
7552 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
7553 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
7554 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
7558 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
7559 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export settings. Here
7561 @cindex headline levels
7562 @cindex section-numbers
7563 @cindex table of contents
7564 @cindex line-break preservation
7565 @cindex quoted HTML tags
7566 @cindex fixed-width sections
7568 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
7570 @cindex special strings
7571 @cindex emphasized text
7572 @cindex @TeX{} macros
7573 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
7574 @cindex author info, in export
7575 @cindex time info, in export
7577 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
7578 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
7579 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
7580 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation}
7581 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
7582 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
7583 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
7584 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
7585 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
7586 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
7587 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
7588 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
7589 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
7590 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
7591 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
7592 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
7593 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
7594 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
7595 LaTeX: @r{turn on/off La@TeX{} fragments}
7596 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
7597 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
7598 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
7599 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
7600 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
7603 These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except
7604 for @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and
7605 @code{nil} for the La@TeX{} export.
7607 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
7608 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
7609 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
7610 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, and @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
7612 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII export, Export options, Exporting
7613 @section The export dispatcher
7614 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
7616 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
7617 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
7618 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
7619 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
7620 the subtrees are exported.
7625 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
7626 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
7627 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
7628 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
7629 separate emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
7630 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
7633 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
7634 (i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
7635 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-e
7636 @item C-u C-u C-c C-e
7637 Call an the exporter, but reverse the setting of
7638 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
7639 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if st.
7642 @node ASCII export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
7643 @section ASCII export
7644 @cindex ASCII export
7646 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
7649 @cindex region, active
7650 @cindex active region
7651 @cindex transient-mark-mode
7655 Export as ASCII file. For an org file @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
7656 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
7657 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{this requires
7658 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
7659 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
7660 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
7661 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
7662 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
7666 Export only the visible part of the document.
7669 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
7670 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
7671 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
7672 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
7673 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
7680 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
7681 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
7682 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
7683 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
7684 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
7685 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
7686 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
7688 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII export, Exporting
7689 @section HTML export
7692 Org mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
7693 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
7694 language, but with additional support for tables.
7697 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
7698 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
7699 * Links:: Transformation of links for HTML
7700 * Images in HTML export::
7701 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
7702 * Javascript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
7705 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
7706 @subsection HTML export commands
7708 @cindex region, active
7709 @cindex active region
7710 @cindex transient-mark-mode
7714 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an org file @file{myfile.org},
7715 the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
7716 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{this requires
7717 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
7718 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
7719 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
7720 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
7721 property, that name will be used for the export.
7724 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
7727 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
7730 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
7731 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
7732 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
7741 Export only the visible part of the document.
7742 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
7743 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org mode
7744 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
7746 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
7747 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
7751 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
7752 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
7753 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
7754 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
7755 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
7762 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
7764 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links, HTML Export commands, HTML export
7765 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
7767 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
7768 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
7769 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
7770 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
7771 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
7772 the exported file use either
7775 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
7779 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
7783 All lines between these markers are exported literally
7788 @node Links, Images in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
7791 @cindex links, in HTML export
7792 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
7793 @cindex external links, in HTML export
7794 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML.
7795 Automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio targets}) will also
7796 work in the HTML file. Links to external files will still work if the HTML
7797 file is in the same directory as the Org file. Links to other @file{.org}
7798 files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption that an HTML
7799 version also exists of the linked file. For information related to linking
7800 files while publishing them to a publishing directory see @ref{Publishing
7803 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
7804 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that wil be added to the
7805 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{alt} and
7806 @code{title} attributes for an inlined image:
7809 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="This is image A" title="Image with no action"
7813 @node Images in HTML export, CSS support, Links, HTML export
7816 @cindex images, inline in HTML
7817 @cindex inlining images in HTML
7818 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
7819 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
7820 default@footnote{but see the variable
7821 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}}, images are inlined if a link does
7822 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
7823 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
7824 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
7825 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
7826 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
7827 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
7828 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
7831 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
7835 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
7837 @node CSS support, Javascript support, Images in HTML export, HTML export
7838 @subsection CSS support
7839 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
7840 @cindex HTML export, CSS
7842 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
7843 assigns the following special CSS classes to appropriate parts of the
7844 document - your style specifications may change these, in addition to any of
7845 the standard classes like for headlines, tables etc.
7847 .todo @r{TODO keywords}
7848 .done @r{the DONE keyword}
7849 .timestamp @r{time stamp}
7850 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a time stamp, like SCHEDULED}
7851 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
7852 .target @r{target for links}
7853 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
7854 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
7855 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
7858 Each exported files contains a compact default style that defines these
7859 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
7860 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
7861 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
7862 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
7863 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
7864 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
7865 granular settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
7866 individually for each file, you can use
7869 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
7873 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
7874 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
7875 referring to an external file.
7877 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
7878 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
7880 @node Javascript support, , CSS support, HTML export
7881 @subsection Javascript supported display of web pages
7883 @emph{Sebastian Rose} has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
7884 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
7885 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one is
7886 an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
7887 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
7888 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
7889 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs.
7890 The script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can
7891 find the documentation for it at
7892 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/org-info.js.html}. We are
7893 serving the script from our site, but if you use it a lot, you might not want
7894 to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local copy on
7895 your own web server.
7897 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
7898 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
7899 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
7900 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
7901 adding a single line to the Org file:
7904 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
7908 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
7909 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
7913 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
7914 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
7915 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
7916 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
7917 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
7918 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
7919 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
7920 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
7921 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
7922 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
7923 @r{@code{org-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
7924 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-headline-levels}, each}
7925 @r{info/folding section can still contain children headlines.}
7926 toc: @r{Should the table of content @emph{initially} be visible?}
7927 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the toc with @kbd{i}.}
7928 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
7929 @r{the variables @code{org-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
7930 ftoc: @r{Does the css of the page specify a fixed position for the toc?}
7931 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
7932 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
7933 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
7934 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
7935 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
7936 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
7939 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
7940 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
7941 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
7943 @node LaTeX and PDF export, XOXO export, HTML export, Exporting
7944 @section LaTeX and PDF export
7945 @cindex LaTeX export
7948 Org mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
7949 further processing, this backend is also used to produce PDF output. Since
7950 the LaTeX output uses @file{hyperref} to implement links and cross
7951 references, the PDF output file will be fully linked.
7954 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invode which commands
7955 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal LaTeX code
7956 * Sectioning structure:: Changing sectioning in LaTeX output
7957 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to LaTeX
7958 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into LaTeX output
7961 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
7962 @subsection LaTeX export commands
7964 @cindex region, active
7965 @cindex active region
7966 @cindex transient-mark-mode
7970 Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an org file
7971 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
7972 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{this
7973 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
7974 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
7975 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
7976 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
7977 property, that name will be used for the export.
7980 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
7985 Export only the visible part of the document.
7986 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
7987 Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was Org mode
7988 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
7990 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
7991 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by La@TeX{}
7995 Export as LaTeX and then process to PDF.
7998 Export as LaTeX and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
8001 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
8002 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
8003 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
8004 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
8005 convert them to a custom string depending on
8006 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
8008 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
8009 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
8016 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
8018 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Sectioning structure, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
8019 @subsection Quoting LaTeX code
8021 Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX} will be correctly
8022 inserted into the La@TeX{} file. Furthermore, you can add special code
8023 that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with the following
8027 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
8031 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
8035 All lines between these markers are exported literally
8039 @node Sectioning structure, Tables in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
8040 @subsection Sectioning structure
8042 @cindex LaTeX sectioning structure
8044 By default, the La@TeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
8046 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
8047 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
8048 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file. The class should be listed in
8049 @code{org-export-latex-classes}, where you can also define the sectioning
8050 structure for each class, as well as defining additonal classes.
8053 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Sectioning structure, LaTeX and PDF export
8054 @subsection Tables in LaTeX export
8055 @cindex tables, in LaTeX export
8057 For LaTeX export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
8058 (@pxref{Tables exported}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
8059 request a longtable environment for the table, so that it may span several
8063 #+CAPTION: A long table
8065 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable
8071 @node Images in LaTeX export, , Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
8072 @subsection Images in LaTeX export
8073 @cindex images, inline in LaTeX
8074 @cindex inlining images in LaTeX
8076 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
8077 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
8078 output files resulting from LaTeX output. Org will use an
8079 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
8080 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Markup rules}, the figure will
8081 be wrappend into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
8082 element. Finally, you can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the
8083 options that can be used in the optional argument of the
8084 @code{\includegraphics} macro.
8087 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
8088 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8089 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
8090 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
8094 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
8095 @section XOXO export
8098 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
8099 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
8100 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
8105 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
8108 Export only the visible part of the document.
8111 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
8112 @section iCalendar export
8113 @cindex iCalendar export
8115 Some people like to use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still
8116 prefer a standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments.
8117 In this case it can be useful to have deadlines and other time-stamped items
8118 in Org files show up in the calendar application. Org mode can export
8119 calendar information in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to
8120 have TODO entries included in the export, configure the variable
8121 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. iCalendar export will export plain time
8122 stamps as VEVENT, and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from
8123 deadlines that are in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO
8124 items will be used to set the start and due dates for the todo
8125 entry@footnote{See the variables @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and
8126 @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}. As categories, it will use the tags
8127 locally defined in the heading, and the file/tree category@footnote{To add
8128 inherited tags or the TODO state, configure the variable
8129 @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}.
8131 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
8132 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
8133 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
8134 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
8135 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
8136 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
8137 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
8138 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
8139 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
8144 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
8145 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
8148 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
8149 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
8150 file will be written.
8153 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
8154 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
8155 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
8158 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
8159 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
8160 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
8161 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
8162 and the description from the body (limited to
8163 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
8165 How this calendar is best read and updated, that depends on the application
8166 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
8168 @node Publishing, Miscellaneous, Exporting, Top
8172 Org includes@footnote{@file{org-publish.el} is not distributed with
8173 Emacs 21, if you are still using Emacs 21, you need you need to download
8174 this file separately.} a publishing management system that allows you to
8175 configure automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of
8176 interlinked org files. This system is called @emph{org-publish}. You can
8177 also configure org-publish to automatically upload your exported HTML
8178 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to
8179 a web server. Org-publish turns Org into a web-site authoring tool.
8181 You can also use Org-publish to convert files into La@TeX{}, or even
8182 combine HTML and La@TeX{} conversion so that files are available in both
8183 formats on the server@footnote{Since La@TeX{} files on a server are not
8184 that helpful, you surely want to perform further conversion on them --
8185 e.g. convert them to @code{PDF} format.}.
8187 Org-publish has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
8190 * Configuration:: Defining projects
8191 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
8192 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
8195 @node Configuration, Sample configuration, Publishing, Publishing
8196 @section Configuration
8198 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
8199 and many other properties of a project.
8202 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
8203 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
8204 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
8205 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
8206 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
8207 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
8208 * Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files
8211 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
8212 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
8213 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
8214 @cindex projects, for publishing
8216 Org-publish is configured almost entirely through setting the value of
8217 one variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
8218 Each element of the list configures one project, and may be in one of
8219 the two following forms:
8222 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
8226 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
8230 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values.
8231 A project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as
8232 the publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When
8233 a project takes the second form listed above, the individual members
8234 of the ``components'' property are taken to be components of the
8235 project, which group together files requiring different publishing
8236 options. When you publish such a ``meta-project'' all the components
8237 will also publish. The @code{:components} are published in the sequence
8240 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
8241 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
8242 @cindex directories, for publishing
8244 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
8245 particular, org-publish needs to know where to look for source files,
8246 and where to put published files.
8248 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
8249 @item @code{:base-directory}
8250 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
8251 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
8252 @tab Directory (possibly remote) where output files will be published.
8253 @item @code{:preparation-function}
8254 @tab Function called before starting the publishing process, for example to
8255 run @code{make} for updating files to be published.
8256 @item @code{:completion-function}
8257 @tab Function called after finishing the publishing process, for example to
8258 change permissions of the resulting files.
8262 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
8263 @subsection Selecting files
8264 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
8266 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
8267 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
8269 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
8270 @item @code{:base-extension}
8271 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
8274 @item @code{:exclude}
8275 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
8276 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
8279 @item @code{:include}
8280 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
8281 and @code{:exclude}.
8284 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
8285 @subsection Publishing action
8286 @cindex action, for publishing
8288 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
8289 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
8290 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
8291 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
8292 export}). But you also can publish your files in La@TeX{} by using the
8293 function @code{org-publish-org-to-latex} instead, or as PDF files using
8294 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}. Other files like images only need to be
8295 copied to the publishing destination. For non-Org files, you need to provide
8296 your own publishing function:
8298 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
8299 @item @code{:publishing-function}
8300 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
8301 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
8304 The function must accept two arguments: a property list containing at
8305 least a @code{:publishing-directory} property, and the name of the file
8306 to be published. It should take the specified file, make the necessary
8307 transformation (if any) and place the result into the destination folder.
8308 You can write your own publishing function, but @code{org-publish}
8309 provides one for attachments (files that only need to be copied):
8310 @code{org-publish-attachment}.
8312 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
8313 @subsection Options for the HTML/LaTeX exporters
8314 @cindex options, for publishing
8316 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
8317 and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
8318 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
8319 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
8320 respective variable for details.
8322 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
8323 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
8324 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
8325 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
8326 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
8327 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
8328 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
8329 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
8330 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
8331 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
8332 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
8333 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
8334 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
8335 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
8336 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
8337 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
8338 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
8339 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
8340 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
8341 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
8342 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
8343 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
8344 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
8345 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
8346 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
8347 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
8348 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
8349 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
8350 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
8351 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
8352 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
8353 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
8354 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
8355 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
8356 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
8357 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
8358 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
8359 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
8360 @item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
8361 @item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
8362 @item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
8363 @item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
8364 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
8365 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address}
8366 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
8367 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
8370 If you use several email addresses, separate them by a semi-column.
8372 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
8373 both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
8374 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
8377 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
8378 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
8379 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
8380 options}), however, override everything.
8382 @node Publishing links, Project page index, Publishing options, Configuration
8383 @subsection Links between published files
8384 @cindex links, publishing
8386 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
8387 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
8388 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). Upon publishing this link
8389 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
8390 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
8391 you publish them to HTML.
8393 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are
8394 careful with relative pathnames, and provided you have also configured
8395 @code{org-publish} to upload the related files, these links will work
8396 too. See @ref{Complex example} for an example of this usage.
8398 Sometime an Org file to be published may contain links that are
8399 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
8400 location. In this case, use the property
8402 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
8403 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
8404 @tab Function to validate links
8408 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
8409 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
8410 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
8411 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
8412 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
8413 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
8414 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
8416 @node Project page index, , Publishing links, Configuration
8417 @subsection Project page index
8418 @cindex index, of published pages
8420 The following properties may be used to control publishing of an
8421 index of files or summary page for a given project.
8423 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
8424 @item @code{:auto-index}
8425 @tab When non-nil, publish an index during org-publish-current-project or
8428 @item @code{:index-filename}
8429 @tab Filename for output of index. Defaults to @file{index.org} (which
8430 becomes @file{index.html}).
8432 @item @code{:index-title}
8433 @tab Title of index page. Defaults to name of file.
8435 @item @code{:index-function}
8436 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of index.
8437 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-index}, which generates a plain list
8438 of links to all files in the project.
8441 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Configuration, Publishing
8442 @section Sample configuration
8444 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
8445 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
8446 more complex, with a multi-component project.
8449 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
8450 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
8453 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
8454 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
8456 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
8457 directory on the local machine.
8460 (setq org-publish-project-alist
8462 :base-directory "~/org/"
8463 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
8464 :section-numbers nil
8465 :table-of-contents nil
8466 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
8467 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
8468 type=\"text/css\">")))
8471 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
8472 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
8474 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
8475 org files converted to HTML, image files, emacs lisp source code, and
8476 style sheets. The publishing-directory is remote and private files are
8479 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
8480 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
8481 paths. For example, if your org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
8482 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you'd link to an image with
8485 file:../images/myimage.png
8488 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
8489 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
8490 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
8493 (setq org-publish-project-alist
8495 :base-directory "~/org/"
8496 :base-extension "org"
8497 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
8498 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
8499 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
8501 :section-numbers nil
8502 :table-of-contents nil
8503 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
8504 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\">"
8506 :auto-postamble nil)
8509 :base-directory "~/images/"
8510 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
8511 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
8512 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
8515 :base-directory "~/other/"
8516 :base-extension "css\\|el"
8517 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
8518 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
8519 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
8522 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
8523 @section Triggering publication
8525 Once org-publish is properly configured, you can publish with the
8526 following functions:
8530 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
8532 Publish the project containing the current file.
8534 Publish only the current file.
8536 Publish all projects.
8539 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above
8540 functions normally only publish changed files. You can override this and
8541 force publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument.
8543 @node Miscellaneous, Extensions, Publishing, Top
8544 @chapter Miscellaneous
8547 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
8548 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
8549 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
8550 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
8551 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
8552 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
8553 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
8554 * Bugs:: Things which do not work perfectly
8557 @node Completion, Customization, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
8559 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
8560 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
8561 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
8562 @cindex completion, of option keywords
8563 @cindex completion, of tags
8564 @cindex completion, of property keys
8565 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
8566 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
8567 @cindex TODO keywords completion
8568 @cindex dictionary word completion
8569 @cindex option keyword completion
8570 @cindex tag completion
8571 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
8573 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
8574 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
8575 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
8580 Complete word at point
8583 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
8585 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
8587 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
8588 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
8590 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
8591 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
8592 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
8593 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
8595 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
8596 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
8599 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
8601 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
8602 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
8603 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
8604 will insert example settings for this keyword.
8606 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
8607 i.e. valid keys for this line.
8609 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
8613 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Completion, Miscellaneous
8614 @section Customization
8615 @cindex customization
8616 @cindex options, for customization
8617 @cindex variables, for customization
8619 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
8620 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
8621 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
8622 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
8623 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
8624 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
8625 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
8627 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
8628 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
8629 @cindex in-buffer settings
8630 @cindex special keywords
8632 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
8633 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
8634 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
8635 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
8636 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
8637 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
8638 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
8639 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
8640 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
8643 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
8644 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
8645 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
8646 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
8647 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
8649 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
8650 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
8651 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
8652 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
8653 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
8654 columns view is invoked in location where no @code{COLUMNS} property
8656 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
8657 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
8658 line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
8659 The global version of this variable is
8660 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
8661 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
8662 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
8664 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
8665 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
8667 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
8668 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
8669 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
8670 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
8671 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
8672 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
8673 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
8674 have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority.
8675 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
8676 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
8677 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
8678 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
8679 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
8680 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
8681 (i.e. when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
8682 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
8683 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particlar, the file can be
8684 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
8685 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
8687 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
8688 Org file is being visited. The first set of options deals with the
8689 initial visibility of the outline tree. The corresponding variable for
8690 global default settings is @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default
8691 value @code{t}, which means @code{overview}.
8692 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
8693 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
8694 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
8696 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
8697 content @r{all headlines}
8698 showall @r{no folding at all, show everything}
8700 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
8701 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
8702 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
8704 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
8705 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
8707 align @r{align all tables}
8708 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
8710 Logging closing and reinstating TODO items, and clock intervals
8711 (variables @code{org-log-done}, @code{org-log-note-clock-out}, and
8712 @code{org-log-repeat}) can be configured using these options.
8713 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
8714 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
8715 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
8716 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
8717 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
8718 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
8719 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
8720 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
8722 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
8723 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
8724 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
8725 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
8726 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
8727 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
8728 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
8729 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
8731 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
8732 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
8733 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
8734 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
8735 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
8736 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
8737 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
8738 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
8740 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
8741 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
8742 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
8743 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
8744 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
8745 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
8747 To turn on custom format overlays over time stamps (variables
8748 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
8749 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
8750 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
8752 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
8754 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
8755 @code{constants-unit-system}).
8756 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
8757 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
8759 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
8760 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
8762 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
8763 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
8764 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
8765 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
8767 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
8768 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+OPTIONS, #+DATE:
8769 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
8770 @ref{Export options}.
8771 @item #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
8772 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
8773 current file. The corresponding variables are @code{org-todo-keywords}
8774 and @code{org-todo-interpretation}.
8777 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
8778 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
8780 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
8782 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
8783 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
8784 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
8785 other circumstances it means something like @emph{Hey Org, look
8786 here and update according to what you see here}. Here is a summary of
8787 what this means in different contexts.
8791 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
8792 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
8794 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
8795 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
8798 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
8799 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
8801 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
8804 If the cursor is inside a table created by the @file{table.el} package,
8805 activate that table.
8807 If the current buffer is a remember buffer, close the note and file it.
8808 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
8811 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
8812 corresponding links in this buffer.
8814 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
8815 drawer, offer property commands.
8817 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
8820 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
8823 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamical block, the
8827 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
8828 @section A cleaner outline view
8829 @cindex hiding leading stars
8830 @cindex dynamic indentation
8831 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
8832 @cindex clean outline view
8834 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines are starting
8835 with a potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines
8836 is not indented. This is not really a problem when you are writing a book
8837 where the outline headings are really section headlines. However, in a more
8838 list-oriented outline, it is clear that an indented structure is a lot
8839 cleaner, as can be seen by comparing the two columns in the following
8844 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
8845 ** Second level | * Second level
8846 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
8847 some text | some text
8848 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
8849 more text | more text
8850 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
8855 It is non-trivial to make such a look work in Emacs, but Org contains three
8856 separate features that, combined, achieve just that.
8860 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
8861 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
8862 with the headline, like
8866 more text, now indented
8869 A good way to get this indentation is by hand, and Org supports this with
8870 paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure editing@footnote{See also the
8871 variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.} preserving or adapting the
8872 indentation appropriate. A different approach would be to have a way to
8873 automatically indent lines according to outline structure by adding overlays
8874 or text properties. But I have not yet found a robust and efficient way to
8875 do this in large files.
8878 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
8879 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
8880 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
8884 #+STARTUP: hidestars
8888 Note that the opposite behavior is selected with @code{showstars}.
8890 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
8894 * Top level headline
8902 Note that the leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they
8903 are only fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the
8904 background color as font color. If you are not using either white or
8905 black background, you may have to customize this face to get the wanted
8906 effect. Another possibility is to set this font such that the extra
8907 stars are @i{almost} invisible, for example using the color
8908 @code{grey90} on a white background.
8911 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
8912 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
8913 to the next. In this way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of
8914 this section. In order to make the structure editing and export commands
8915 handle this convention correctly, configure the variable
8916 @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on a per-file basis with one of the
8924 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
8925 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
8926 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
8927 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
8930 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
8931 @section Using Org on a tty
8932 @cindex tty key bindings
8934 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default much of
8935 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
8936 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
8937 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
8938 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
8939 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
8940 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
8941 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
8942 customized work-around suits you better. For example, changing a time
8943 stamp is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
8944 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
8946 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.2
8947 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
8948 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab
8949 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
8950 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab
8951 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x i} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
8952 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab
8953 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
8954 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab
8955 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
8956 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab
8957 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab
8958 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
8959 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab
8960 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab
8961 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab
8962 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab
8963 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab
8964 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab
8965 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab
8968 @node Interaction, Bugs, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
8969 @section Interaction with other packages
8970 @cindex packages, interaction with other
8971 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
8972 with other code out there.
8975 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
8976 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
8979 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
8980 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
8983 @cindex @file{calc.el}
8984 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
8985 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
8986 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
8987 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
8988 @code{calc-eval} which should be autoloaded in your setup if Calc has
8989 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
8990 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
8991 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
8992 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
8993 @cindex @file{constants.el}
8994 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
8995 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
8996 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
8997 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
8998 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
8999 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
9000 @samp{Mega} etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
9001 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
9002 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
9003 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
9004 @file{constants.el}.
9005 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
9006 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
9007 Org mode can make use of the CDLaTeX package to efficiently enter
9008 La@TeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
9009 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
9010 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
9011 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
9012 supports Imenu - all you need to do to get the index is the following:
9014 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
9015 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
9017 By default the index is two levels deep - you can modify the depth using
9018 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
9019 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
9020 @cindex @file{remember.el}
9021 Org cooperates with remember, see @ref{Remember}.
9022 @file{Remember.el} is not part of Emacs, find it on the web.
9023 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
9024 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
9025 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
9026 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
9027 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows to
9028 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
9029 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
9030 @cindex @file{table.el}
9031 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
9033 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
9034 @cindex @file{table.el}
9036 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and
9037 row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table
9038 package by Takaaki Ota (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table},
9039 and also part of Emacs 22).
9040 When @key{TAB} or @kbd{C-c C-c} is pressed in such a table, Org mode
9041 will call @command{table-recognize-table} and move the cursor into the
9042 table. Inside a table, the keymap of Org mode is inactive. In order
9043 to execute Org mode-related commands, leave the table.
9048 Recognize @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a
9053 Insert a table.el table. If there is already a table at point, this
9054 command converts it between the table.el format and the Org mode
9055 format. See the documentation string of the command
9056 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
9059 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs 22.
9060 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9061 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
9062 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package
9063 (@pxref{Footnotes}).
9066 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
9067 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
9071 @cindex @file{allout.el}
9072 @item @file{allout.el} by Ken Manheimer
9073 Startup of Org may fail with the error message
9074 @code{(wrong-type-argument keymapp nil)} when there is an outdated
9075 version @file{allout.el} on the load path, for example the version
9076 distributed with Emacs 21.x. Upgrade to Emacs 22 and this problem will
9077 disappear. If for some reason you cannot do this, make sure that org.el
9078 is loaded @emph{before} @file{allout.el}, for example by putting
9079 @code{(require 'org)} early enough into your @file{.emacs} file.
9081 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
9082 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
9083 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by
9084 CUA mode (as well as pc-select-mode and s-region-mode) to select and
9085 extend the region. If you want to use one of these packages along with
9086 Org, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When
9087 set, Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and
9088 in the agenda buffer (but not during date selection).
9091 S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
9092 S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
9095 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
9096 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
9097 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
9098 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
9099 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
9100 Also this package uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
9101 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here.
9103 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9104 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
9105 Org supports the syntax of the footnote package, but only the
9106 numerical footnote markers. Also, the default key for footnote
9107 commands, @kbd{C-c !} is already used by Org. You could use the
9108 variable @code{footnote-prefix} to switch footnotes commands to another
9109 key. Or, you could use @code{org-replace-disputed-keys} and
9110 @code{org-disputed-keys} to change the settings in Org.
9115 @node Bugs, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
9119 Here is a list of things that should work differently, but which I
9120 have found too hard to fix.
9124 If a table field starts with a link, and if the corresponding table
9125 column is narrowed (@pxref{Narrow columns}) to a width too small to
9126 display the link, the field would look entirely empty even though it is
9127 not. To prevent this, Org throws an error. The work-around is to
9128 make the column wide enough to fit the link, or to add some text (at
9129 least 2 characters) before the link in the same field.
9131 Narrowing table columns does not work on XEmacs, because the
9132 @code{format} function does not transport text properties.
9134 Text in an entry protected with the @samp{QUOTE} keyword should not
9137 When the application called by @kbd{C-c C-o} to open a file link fails
9138 (for example because the application does not exist or refuses to open
9139 the file), it does so silently. No error message is displayed.
9141 Recalculating a table line applies the formulas from left to right.
9142 If a formula uses @emph{calculated} fields further down the row,
9143 multiple recalculation may be needed to get all fields consistent. You
9144 may use the command @code{org-table-iterate} (@kbd{C-u C-c *}) to
9145 recalculate until convergence.
9147 The exporters work well, but could be made more efficient.
9151 @node Extensions, Hacking, Miscellaneous, Top
9152 @appendix Extensions
9154 This appendix lists the extension modules that have been written for Org.
9155 Many of these extensions live in the @file{contrib} directory of the Org
9156 distribution, others are available somewhere on the web.
9159 * Extensions in the contrib directory:: These come with the Org distro
9160 * Other extensions:: These you have to find on the web.
9163 @node Extensions in the contrib directory, Other extensions, Extensions, Extensions
9164 @section Extensions in the @file{contrib} directory
9166 A number of extension are distributed with Org when you download it from its
9167 homepage. Please note that these extensions are @emph{not} distributed as
9168 part of Emacs, so if you use Org as delivered with Emacs, you still need to
9169 go to @url{http://orgmode.org} to get access to these modules.
9172 @item @file{org-annotate-file.el} by @i{Philip Jackson}
9173 Annotate a file with org syntax, in a separate file, with links back to
9175 @item @file{org-annotation-helper.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry and Daniel E. German}
9176 Call @i{remember} directly from Firefox/Opera, or from Adobe Reader.
9177 When activating a special link or bookmark, Emacs receives a trigger to
9178 create a note with a link back to the website. Requires some setup, a
9179 detailes description is in
9180 @file{contrib/packages/org-annotation-helper}.
9181 @item @file{org-bookmark.el} by @i{Tokuya Kameshima}
9182 Support for links to Emacs bookmarks.
9183 @item @file{org-depend.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
9184 TODO dependencies for Org-mode. Make TODO state changes in one entry
9185 trigger changes in another, or be blocked by the state of another
9186 entry. Also, easily create chains of TODO items with exactly one
9187 active item at any time.
9188 @item @file{org-elisp-symbol.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
9189 Org links to emacs-lisp symbols. This can create annotated links that
9190 exactly point to the definition location of a variable of function.
9191 @item @file{org-eval.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
9192 The @code{<lisp>} tag, adapted from Emacs Wiki and Emacs Muse, allows
9193 text to be included in a document that is the result of evaluating some
9194 code. Other scripting languages like @code{perl} can be supported with
9195 this package as well.
9196 @item @file{org-eval-light.el} by @i{Eric Schulte}
9197 User-controlled evaluation of code in an Org buffer.
9198 @item @file{org-exp-blocks.el} by @i{Eric Schulte}
9199 Preprocess user-defined blocks for export.
9200 @item @file{org-expiry.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
9201 Expiry mechanism for Org entries.
9202 @item @file{org-indent.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
9203 Dynamic indentation of Org outlines. The plan is to indent an outline
9204 according to level, but so far this is too hard for a proper and stable
9205 implementation. Still, it works somewhat.
9206 @item @file{org-interactive-query.el} by @i{Christopher League}
9207 Interactive modification of tags queries. After running a general
9208 query in Org, this package allows to narrow down the results by adding
9209 more tags or keywords.
9210 @item @file{org-mairix.el} by @i{Georg C. F. Greve}
9211 Hook mairix search into Org for different MUAs.
9212 @item @file{org-man.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
9213 Support for links to manpages in Org-mode.
9214 @item @file{org-mtags.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
9215 Support for some Muse-like tags in Org-mode. This package allows you
9216 to write @code{<example>} and @code{<src>} and other syntax copied from
9217 Emacs Muse, right inside an Org file. The goal here is to make it easy
9218 to publish the same file using either org-publish or Muse.
9219 @item @file{org-panel.el} by @i{Lennard Borgman}
9220 Simplified and display-aided access to some Org commands.
9221 @item @file{org-registry.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
9222 A registry for Org links, to find out from where links point to a given
9224 @item @file{org2rem.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
9225 Convert org appointments into reminders for the @file{remind} program.
9226 @item @file{org-screen.el} by @i{Andrew Hyatt}
9227 Visit screen sessions through Org-mode links.
9228 @item @file{org-toc.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
9229 Table of contents in a separate buffer, with fast access to sections
9230 and easy visibility cycling.
9231 @item @file{orgtbl-sqlinsert.el} by @i{Jason Riedy}
9232 Convert Org-mode tables to SQL insertions. Documentation for this can
9233 be found on the Worg pages.
9236 @node Other extensions, , Extensions in the contrib directory, Extensions
9237 @section Other extensions
9241 @node Hacking, History and Acknowledgments, Extensions, Top
9244 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
9248 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
9249 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs
9250 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
9251 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
9252 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
9253 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
9256 @node Adding hyperlink types, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking, Hacking
9257 @section Adding hyperlink types
9258 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
9260 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
9261 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, it
9262 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file
9263 @file{org-man.el} that will add support for creating links like
9264 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
9268 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
9272 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
9273 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
9275 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
9276 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
9278 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
9280 (defun org-man-open (path)
9281 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
9282 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
9283 (funcall org-man-command path))
9285 (defun org-man-store-link ()
9286 "Store a link to a manpage."
9287 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
9288 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
9289 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
9290 (link (concat "man:" page))
9291 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
9292 (org-store-link-props
9295 :description description))))
9297 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
9298 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
9299 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
9300 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
9301 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
9302 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
9306 ;;; org-man.el ends here
9310 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
9317 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
9320 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
9323 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
9324 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
9325 that will be called to follow such a link.
9327 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
9328 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
9329 buffer displaying a man page.
9332 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
9333 First there is a customization variable that determines which emacs
9334 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
9335 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
9336 defined. It gets the link path as an argument - in this case the link
9337 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
9338 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
9340 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
9341 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, also this function will be called to
9342 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
9343 create the link for this buffer type, we do this by checking the value
9344 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
9345 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
9346 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
9347 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
9348 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
9349 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
9350 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
9351 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9353 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
9354 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
9355 @cindex tables, in other modes
9356 @cindex lists, in other modes
9359 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
9360 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
9361 specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely
9362 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
9363 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
9367 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
9368 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
9369 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
9370 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
9371 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
9372 for a very flexible system.
9374 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists. You can use Org's
9375 facilities to edit and structure lists by turning @code{orgstruct-mode}
9376 on, then locally exporting such lists in another format (HTML, La@TeX{}
9381 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving
9382 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
9383 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
9384 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
9387 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
9388 @subsection Radio tables
9389 @cindex radio tables
9391 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
9392 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
9393 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
9394 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
9397 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
9398 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
9402 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
9403 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
9406 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
9410 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
9411 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
9412 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
9413 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
9414 passed as a property list to the translation function for
9415 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
9416 acted upon before the translation function is called:
9420 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
9423 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
9424 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
9425 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
9426 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
9427 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
9432 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
9433 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
9434 compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a
9435 number of different solutions:
9439 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
9440 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
9441 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
9443 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
9444 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in TeX and @samp{\end@{document@}}
9447 You can just comment the table line by line whenever you want to process
9448 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
9449 only sounds tedious - the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment} does
9450 make this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
9454 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
9455 @subsection A LaTeX example of radio tables
9456 @cindex LaTeX, and Orgtbl mode
9458 The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the
9459 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
9460 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
9461 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
9462 default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
9463 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
9464 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
9465 be prompted for a table name, lets say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
9466 will then get the following template:
9468 @cindex #+ORGTBL: SEND
9470 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9471 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9473 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
9479 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
9480 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it
9481 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
9482 fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
9483 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
9484 this may cause problems with font-lock in LaTeX mode. As shown in the
9485 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
9486 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
9487 expressions. If you are using AUCTeX with the font-latex library, a
9488 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
9489 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
9492 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9493 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9495 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
9496 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
9497 |-------+------+---------+---------|
9498 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
9499 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
9500 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
9501 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
9502 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
9507 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
9508 table inserted between the two marker lines.
9510 Now lets assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
9511 want to control how columns are aligned etc. In this case we make sure
9512 that the table translator does skip the first 2 lines of the source
9513 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
9514 header and footer commands of the target table:
9517 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
9518 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
9519 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9520 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9524 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
9525 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
9526 |-------+------+---------+---------|
9527 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
9528 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
9529 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
9530 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
9534 The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
9535 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
9536 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
9537 interprets the following parameters (see also @ref{Translator functions}):
9541 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
9542 tabular environment. Default is nil.
9545 A format to be used to wrap each field, should contain @code{%s} for the
9546 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
9547 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
9548 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
9549 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
9550 function must return a formatted string.
9553 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
9554 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
9555 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
9556 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
9557 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
9558 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
9559 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
9560 supplied instead of strings.
9563 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
9564 @subsection Translator functions
9565 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
9566 @cindex translator function
9568 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
9569 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
9570 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
9571 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
9572 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
9573 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
9574 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
9575 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
9576 hands over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
9580 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
9581 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
9582 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
9583 org-table-last-alignment ""))
9586 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
9587 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
9588 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
9589 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
9590 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
9594 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
9595 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
9596 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
9597 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
9598 would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
9599 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
9600 overrule the default with
9603 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
9606 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
9607 analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
9608 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
9609 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
9610 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!} and where the field
9611 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
9615 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
9616 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
9620 Please check the documentation string of the function
9621 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
9622 that function and remember that you can pass each of them into
9623 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
9624 using the generic function.
9626 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
9627 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
9628 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
9629 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
9630 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
9631 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
9632 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
9633 translator, please post it on @code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
9634 others can benefit from your work.
9636 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
9637 @subsection Radio lists
9639 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
9641 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way than
9642 sending and receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}) @footnote{You
9643 need to load the @code{org-export-latex.el} package to use radio lists
9644 since the relevant code is there for now.}. As for radio tables, you
9645 can insert radio lists templates in HTML, La@TeX{} and Texinfo modes by
9646 calling @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
9648 Here are the differences with radio tables:
9652 Use @code{ORGLST} instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
9654 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
9657 `C-c C-c' will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
9660 Here is a La@TeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
9664 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
9665 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
9667 #+ORGLIST: SEND to-buy orgtbl-to-latex
9676 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
9677 La@TeX{} list between the two marker lines.
9679 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
9680 @section Dynamic blocks
9681 @cindex dynamic blocks
9683 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
9684 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
9685 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
9686 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
9688 Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
9689 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
9690 the content of the block.
9692 #+BEGIN:dynamic block
9694 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
9699 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
9704 Update dynamic block at point.
9705 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
9706 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
9707 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
9710 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
9711 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
9712 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
9713 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
9714 extra parameter @code{:content}.
9716 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
9717 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
9718 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
9719 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
9723 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
9729 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
9732 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
9733 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
9734 (insert "Last block update at: "
9735 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
9738 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
9739 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
9740 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
9741 written in a way that is does nothing in buffers that are not in
9744 @node Special agenda views, Using the property API, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
9745 @section Special agenda views
9746 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
9748 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the
9749 selection made by any of the agenda views. You may specify a function
9750 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part
9751 of the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped.
9753 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
9754 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
9755 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
9756 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
9757 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
9758 the subtree belonging to the project line.
9760 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
9761 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
9762 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
9763 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
9764 search should continue from there.
9767 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
9768 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
9769 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
9770 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
9771 nil ; tag found, do not skip
9772 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
9775 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
9779 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
9780 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
9781 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
9782 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
9785 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
9786 meaningful header in the agenda view.
9788 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
9789 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
9790 your custom search function, simply do a search for @samp{LEVEL>0}, and then
9791 use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries you really want to
9794 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
9795 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
9796 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
9799 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
9800 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
9801 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
9802 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
9803 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
9804 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
9805 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
9806 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
9807 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
9808 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
9809 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
9810 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
9811 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
9812 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
9815 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
9816 like this, even without defining a special function:
9819 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
9820 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
9821 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
9822 'regexp ":waiting:"))
9823 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
9826 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Special agenda views, Hacking
9827 @section Using the property API
9828 @cindex API, for properties
9829 @cindex properties, API
9831 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
9834 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
9835 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.
9836 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
9837 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
9838 entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times
9839 if the property key was used several times.
9840 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
9841 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
9842 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
9844 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
9845 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
9846 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
9847 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
9848 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
9849 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
9850 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
9853 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
9854 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
9857 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
9858 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
9861 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
9862 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
9865 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
9866 Insert a property drawer at point.
9869 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
9870 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
9871 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
9874 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
9875 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
9876 values and return the values as a list of strings.
9879 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
9880 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
9881 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
9884 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
9885 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
9886 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
9889 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
9890 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
9891 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
9894 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
9895 @section Using the mapping API
9896 @cindex API, for mapping
9897 @cindex mapping entries, API
9899 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
9900 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
9901 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
9902 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
9905 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
9906 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
9908 FUNC is a function or a lisp form. The function will be called without
9909 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
9910 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
9913 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
9914 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
9915 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
9916 visited by the iteration.
9918 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
9921 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
9922 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
9923 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
9925 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
9926 agenda @r{all agenda files}
9927 agenda-with-archives
9928 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
9930 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
9933 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
9934 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
9937 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
9938 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
9939 function or Lisp form
9940 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
9941 @r{so whenever the the function returns t, FUNC}
9942 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
9943 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
9947 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
9948 It can uce the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
9949 information about the entry, or in order to change metadate in the entry.
9950 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
9952 @defun org-todo &optional arg
9953 Change the TODO state of the entry, see the docstring of the functions for
9954 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
9957 @defun org-priority &optional action
9958 Change the priority of the entry, see the docstring of this function for the
9959 possible values for ACTION.
9962 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
9963 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
9964 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
9968 Promote the current entry.
9972 Demote the current entry.
9975 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
9976 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
9977 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
9981 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
9982 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
9985 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
9986 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
9989 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
9992 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, Hacking, Top
9993 @appendix History and Acknowledgments
9994 @cindex acknowledgments
9998 Org was borne in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface
9999 of the Emacs Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and
10000 projects, and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However,
10001 having to remember eleven different commands with two or three keys per
10002 command, only to hide and show parts of the outline tree, that seemed
10003 entirely unacceptable to me. Also, when using outlines to take notes, I
10004 constantly want to restructure the tree, organizing it parallel to my
10005 thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility cycling} and @emph{structure
10006 editing} were originally implemented in the package
10007 @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
10008 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project
10009 planning, the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{time
10010 stamps}, and @emph{table support}. These areas highlight the two main
10011 goals that Org still has today: To create a new, outline-based,
10012 plain text mode with innovative and intuitive editing features, and to
10013 incorporate project planning functionality directly into a notes file.
10015 A special thanks goes to @i{Bastien Guerry} who has not only writen a large
10016 number of extensions to Org (most of them integrated into the core by now),
10017 but has also helped the development and maintenance of Org so much that he
10018 should be considered co-author of this package.
10020 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or on
10021 @code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
10022 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
10023 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
10024 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
10025 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
10026 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
10032 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
10034 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
10036 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
10039 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding time stamps.
10041 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
10044 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
10047 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for lisp forms into table
10048 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
10049 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
10051 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested to copy some linking code from Planner.
10053 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
10054 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
10057 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
10058 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
10059 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
10061 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
10062 patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and inspired the agenda.
10064 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
10067 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
10069 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
10071 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
10072 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
10074 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
10076 @i{Bastien Guerry} wrote the La@TeX{} exporter and @file{org-bibtex.el}, and
10077 has been prolific with patches, ideas, and bug reports.
10079 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
10081 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
10082 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
10083 been critical when we started to adopt the GIT version control system.
10085 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixed and
10088 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
10090 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
10091 folded entries, and column view for properties.
10093 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
10095 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also
10096 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
10098 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
10100 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
10102 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
10105 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
10108 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed to allow multiple TODO sequences in a file
10109 and to be able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
10111 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and elisp forms.
10113 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
10114 file links, and TAGS.
10116 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
10119 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
10121 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
10122 links, among other things.
10124 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
10125 provided frequent feedback.
10127 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
10129 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
10132 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
10134 @i{Sebastian Rose} wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
10135 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like, or a folding interface with
10136 single key navigation.
10138 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
10139 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
10141 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for orgtbl tables with
10144 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
10145 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
10147 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
10150 @i{Eric Schulte} wrote @file{org-plot.el}.
10152 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
10153 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
10155 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
10156 examples, adn remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
10158 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
10159 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
10161 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
10164 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
10166 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
10167 tweaks and features.
10169 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
10170 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
10172 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
10173 with links transformation to Org syntax.
10175 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
10176 chapter about publishing.
10178 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
10181 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
10184 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
10187 @i{John Wiegley} wrote @file{emacs-wiki.el}, @file{planner.el}, and
10188 @file{muse.el}, which have similar goals as Org. Initially the
10189 development of Org was fully independent because I was not aware of the
10190 existence of these packages. But with time I have accasionally looked
10191 at John's code and learned a lot from it. John has also contributed a
10192 number of great ideas and patches directly to Org, including the attachment
10193 system (@file{org-attach.el}) and integration with Apple Mail
10194 (@file{org-mac-message.el}).
10196 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
10199 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
10202 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
10203 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
10207 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
10208 @unnumbered The Main Index
10212 @node Key Index, , Main Index, Top
10213 @unnumbered Key Index
10220 arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
10223 @c Local variables:
10224 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "en_US-w_accents"
10225 @c ispell-local-pdict: "./.aspell.org.pws"